blob: 3ecfe77e1492c5bd4b9381381688871d15ca8149 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Amaury Denoyelled4759ba2021-04-12 11:12:24 +02007 2021/04/12
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194
1951.2. HTTP request
196-----------------
197
198First, let's consider this HTTP request :
199
200 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100201 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
203 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
204 3 User-agent: my small browser
205 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
206 5 Accept: image/png
207
208
2091.2.1. The Request line
210-----------------------
211
212Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
213
214 - a METHOD : GET
215 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
217
218All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
219which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
220followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
221is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
222desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
223the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
224
225The URI itself can have several forms :
226
227 - A "relative URI" :
228
229 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230
231 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
232 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
233
234 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
235
236 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
237
238 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
239 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
240 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
241 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
242 must accept this form too.
243
244 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
245 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
246 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200248 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
249 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
250 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
251 other protocols too.
252
253In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
254mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
255on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
256It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
257specific to the language, framework or application in use.
258
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100259HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100260assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262
2631.2.2. The request headers
264--------------------------
265
266The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
267beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
268an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
269Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
270values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
271encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
272the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
273define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau371ab182020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200278as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
279normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
280representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
281HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
283The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
284that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
285is one valid form of empty line.
286
287Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
288headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
289about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
290application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
291
292Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000293 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
295 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
296 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
297
298
2991.3. HTTP response
300------------------
301
302An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
303messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
304
305 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100306 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
308 2 Content-length: 350
309 3 Content-Type: text/html
310
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200311As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
312codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
313response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100314continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
315the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
316following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
317sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
318(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
319correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
320such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
321state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
322over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
323if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
324information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003271.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328------------------------
329
330Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
331
332 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
333 - a status code : 200
334 - a reason : OK
335
336The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100337 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
338 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
339 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
340 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
341 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000343Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100344"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
346messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
347or "Authentication Required".
348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350
351 Code When / reason
352 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
353 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
354 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
355 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100356 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
357 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358 400 for an invalid or too large request
359 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
360 accessing the stats page)
361 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
Florian Tham9f3bda02020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100362 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100364 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
365 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
367 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
368 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
369 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
370 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
371 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
372 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
373
374The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3754.2).
376
377
3781.3.2. The response headers
379---------------------------
380
381Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
382the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
383details.
384
385
3862. Configuring HAProxy
387----------------------
388
3892.1. Configuration file format
390------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200391
392HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
393
394 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
395 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
396 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
397 "frontend" and "backend".
398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100399The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
400referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200401delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200403
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004042.2. Quoting and escaping
405-------------------------
406
407HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
408many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
409with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
410single quotes.
411
412If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
413them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
414escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
415
416Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
417
418 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
419 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
420 \\ to use a backslash
421 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
422 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
423
424Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
425the interpretation of:
426
427 space as a parameter separator
428 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
429 # hash as a comment start
430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200431Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
432-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
433backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
434
435Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200436quoting.
437
438Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
439nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
440
441Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
442equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
443
444 Example:
445 # those are equivalents:
446 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
447 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
448 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
451
452 # those are equivalents:
453 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
454 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
457
458
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004592.3. Environment variables
460--------------------------
461
462HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
463interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
464configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
465optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
466shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
467underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
468
469 Example:
470
471 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
472
473 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
474
475 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
476
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200477Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
478file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
481 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
483* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
484 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
485 directory.
486
487* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
488
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500489* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200490 processes, separated by semicolons.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 CLI, separated by semicolons.
494
495See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200496
4972.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200498----------------
499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100500Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100501values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
502otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
503numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
504for every keyword. Supported units are :
505
506 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
507 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
508 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
509 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
510 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
511 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
512
513
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005142.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200515-------------
516
517 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
518 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
519 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
520 global
521 daemon
522 maxconn 256
523
524 defaults
525 mode http
526 timeout connect 5000ms
527 timeout client 50000ms
528 timeout server 50000ms
529
530 frontend http-in
531 bind *:80
532 default_backend servers
533
534 backend servers
535 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
536
537
538 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
539 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
540 global
541 daemon
542 maxconn 256
543
544 defaults
545 mode http
546 timeout connect 5000ms
547 timeout client 50000ms
548 timeout server 50000ms
549
550 listen http-in
551 bind *:80
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
556
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100557 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200558
559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005603. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561--------------------
562
563Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
564are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
565of them have command-line equivalents.
566
567The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
568
569 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200570 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - description
576 - deviceatlas-json-file
577 - deviceatlas-log-level
578 - deviceatlas-separator
579 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900580 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - gid
582 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100583 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200584 - h1-case-adjust
585 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100588 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200590 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200592 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - presetenv
596 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - uid
598 - ulimit-n
599 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200600 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100601 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200602 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200603 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-options
606 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-options
609 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100610 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100611 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100613 - 51degrees-data-file
614 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200615 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200616 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200617 - wurfl-data-file
618 - wurfl-information-list
619 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200623 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200625 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100626 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100627 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100628 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200629 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200630 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200631 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 - noepoll
634 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000635 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100637 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000639 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100640 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200641 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200642 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200643 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000644 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000645 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - tune.buffers.limit
647 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200649 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100650 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200651 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200652 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200653 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100654 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200655 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200656 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100657 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100658 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100659 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.session-timeout
661 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200662 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100663 - tune.maxaccept
664 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200666 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200667 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua5e11c02020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200668 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
669 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100670 - tune.rcvbuf.client
671 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100672 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200673 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100674 - tune.sndbuf.client
675 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100676 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200678 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100679 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200680 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200681 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100682 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100684 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200685 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
686 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
687 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100688 - tune.zlib.memlevel
689 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691 * Debugging
692 - debug
693 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694
695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697------------------------------------
698
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200699ca-base <dir>
700 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200701 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
702 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704chroot <jail dir>
705 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
706 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
707 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
708 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
709 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
713 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
714 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
715 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
716 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
717 set. These sets have the format
718
719 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
720
721 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
724 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100725 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
726 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
732 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
733 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
734 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100736 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
737 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
738 on the machine's word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
742 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
743 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
744 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
745 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
746 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747
748 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
750
751 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
752 # first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
755 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
756 # word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
763
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
765 # and so on.
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100770 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
772 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
773 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
774
775 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
776 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
777 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
778
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
780 # and a thread range.
781 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
784
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200785crt-base <dir>
786 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
787 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
788 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790daemon
791 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
792 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100793 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
794 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200796deviceatlas-json-file <path>
797 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799
800deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
803
804deviceatlas-separator <char>
805 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
806 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
807
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100808deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200809 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
810 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
811 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100812
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900813external-check
814 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
815 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
816 See "option external-check".
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818gid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700819 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
821 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100822 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
823 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100826group <group name>
827 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
828 See also "gid" and "user".
829
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100830hard-stop-after <time>
831 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
832
833 Arguments :
834 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
835 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
836 SIGUSR1 signal.
837
838 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
839 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
840 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
841
842 Example:
843 global
844 hard-stop-after 30s
845
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200846h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
847 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
848 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
849 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
850 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500851 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200852 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
853 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
854 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
855 specified in a proxy.
856
857 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
858 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
859 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
860 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
861 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
862 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
863 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
864
865 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
866 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
867 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
868 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
869 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
874
875 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
876 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
877
878h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
879 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
880 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
881 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
882 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
883 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
884 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
885 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
886 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
887
888 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
889 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
890 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200895log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
896 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100897 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100899 configured with "log global".
900
901 <address> can be one of:
902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100903 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
905 port).
906
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100907 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
908 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
909 port).
910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100911 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100912 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
913 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100914 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100916 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
917 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
918 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
919 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
920 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
921 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
922 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
923 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
924 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
925 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
926 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
927 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
928 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
929 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100930 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
931 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100932
933 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
934 "fd@2", see above.
935
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200936 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
937 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100938
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200939 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
940 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
941 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
942 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
943 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
944 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
945 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
946 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
947 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
948 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
950 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200951
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200952 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
953 one of the following :
954
955 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
956 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
957
958 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
960
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100961 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
962 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
963 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
964 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
965 logger consumes.
966
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100967 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
968 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
969 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
970 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
973 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
974 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
975 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
976 set with <sample_size> parameter.
977
978 <sample_size>
979 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
980 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
981 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
982 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
983 (see also <ranges> parameter).
984
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100985 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100987 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
988 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
989 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
990
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100991 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
992 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
993 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
994 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995
996 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200997 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
998 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
999 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1000 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1001 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1002 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001004 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001006log-send-hostname [<string>]
1007 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1008 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1009 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1010 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1011 the logs.
1012
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001013log-tag <string>
1014 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1015 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1016 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001017 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001018
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001019lua-load <file>
1020 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1021 used multiple times.
1022
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001023master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001024 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1025 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1026 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001027 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001028 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1029 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001030 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1031 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1032 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1033 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1034 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001035
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001036 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001037
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001038mworker-max-reloads <number>
1039 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001040 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001041 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1042 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1043 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045nbproc <number>
1046 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1047 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1048 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001049 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1050 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001051 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1052 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001054nbthread <number>
1055 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001056 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1057 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1058 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1059 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1060 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001061 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1062 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1063 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1064 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1065 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1066 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1067 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001070 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1072 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1073
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001074presetenv <name> <value>
1075 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1076 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1077 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1078 and "unsetenv".
1079
1080resetenv [<name> ...]
1081 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1082 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1083 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1084 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1085 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1086 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1087 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1088 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1089
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001090stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001091 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1092 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1093 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1094 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1095 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1096 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001097 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001098 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1099 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1100 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1101 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001102
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001103server-state-base <directory>
1104 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001105 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1106 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001107
1108server-state-file <file>
1109 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1110 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1111 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1112 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1113 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1114 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1115 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1116 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001117 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1118 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001119
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001120setenv <name> <value>
1121 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1122 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1123 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1124 and "unsetenv".
1125
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001126set-dumpable
1127 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1128 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1129 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1130 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1131 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1132 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1133 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1134 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1135 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1136 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1137 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1138 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1139 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1140 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1141 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1142 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1143 expected when dying.
1144
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001145ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1147 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001148 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001149 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001150 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1151 information and recommendations see e.g.
1152 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1153 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1154 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1155 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001156
1157ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1159 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1160 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1161 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1162 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001163 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1164 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1165 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001166 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001167
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001168ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1170 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1171 keyword to see available options.
1172
1173 Example:
1174 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001175 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001176
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001177ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1179 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001180 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001182 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1183 information and recommendations see e.g.
1184 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1185 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1186 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1187 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1188 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001189
1190ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1192 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1193 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1194 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1195 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001196 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1197 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1198 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1199 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001200
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001201ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1203 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1204 keyword to see available options.
1205
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001206ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1208 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1209 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001210 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001211 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001212 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1213 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1214 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1215 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001216 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1217 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1218 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1219
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001220ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1221 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1222 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1223 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1224
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001225stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1226 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1227 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1228 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001229 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001230 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001231
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001232 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1233 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1234 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001235
1236stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1237 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1238 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001239 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001240
1241stats maxconn <connections>
1242 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1243 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245uid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001246 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1248 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1249 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1250
1251ulimit-n <number>
1252 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1253 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1254 option.
1255
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001256unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1257 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1258
1259 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1260 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1261 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1262 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1263 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1264 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1265 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1266 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1267 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1268 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270unsetenv [<name> ...]
1271 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1272 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1273 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1274 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1275 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1276 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1277 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279user <user name>
1280 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1281 See also "uid" and "group".
1282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001283node <name>
1284 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1285
1286 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1287 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1288 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1289 traffic.
1290
1291description <text>
1292 Add a text that describes the instance.
1293
1294 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1295 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1296 "<" and ">" characters.
1297
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129851degrees-data-file <file path>
1299 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001301
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001302 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1304
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001306 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1307 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1308 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1309
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001310 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1312
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001314 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1315 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
132051degrees-cache-size <number>
1321 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1322 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1323 By default, this cache is disabled.
1324
1325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001328wurfl-data-file <file path>
1329 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1330 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1331
1332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1333 with USE_WURFL=1.
1334
1335wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1336 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1337 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1338 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1339
1340 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1341
1342 Valid WURFL properties are:
1343 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1344
1345 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1346 device.
1347
1348 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1349 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1350
1351 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1352 particular web request.
1353
1354 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1355 used Libwurfl API version.
1356
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001357 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1358 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1359
1360 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1361 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1362
1363 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1364
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1366 with USE_WURFL=1.
1367
1368wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1369 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1370 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1371
1372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1373 with USE_WURFL=1.
1374
1375wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1376 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1377 thus before the chroot.
1378
1379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1380 with USE_WURFL=1.
1381
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001382wurfl-cache-size <size>
1383 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1384 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001385 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001386 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1389 with USE_WURFL=1.
1390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001392-----------------------
1393
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001394busy-polling
1395 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1396 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1397 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1398 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1399 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1400 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1401 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1402 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1403 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1404 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1405 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1406 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1407 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1408 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1409 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1410 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1411 "poll" pollers.
1412
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001413 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1414 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1415 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1416
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001417max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1418 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1419 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1420 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1421 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1422 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1423 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1424 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1425 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427maxconn <number>
1428 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1429 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1430 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001431 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1432 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1433 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1434 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001435 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1436 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1437 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1438 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1439 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1440 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001442maxconnrate <number>
1443 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1444 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1445 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1446 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1447 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1448 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1449 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1450 fairness.
1451
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001452maxcomprate <number>
1453 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001454 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001455 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1456 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1457 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001459 default value.
1460
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001461maxcompcpuusage <number>
1462 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1463 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1464 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1465 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1466 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1467 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1468 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1469 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1470
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001471maxpipes <number>
1472 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1473 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1474 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1475 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1476 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1477 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1478
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001479maxsessrate <number>
1480 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1481 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1482 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1483 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1484 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1485 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1486 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1487 fairness.
1488
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001489maxsslconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1491 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1492 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1493 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1494 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1495 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1496 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001497 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1498 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1499 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1500 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1501 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1502 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1503 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001504
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001505maxsslrate <number>
1506 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1507 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1508 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1509 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1510 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1511 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1512 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1513 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1514 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1515 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1516
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001517maxzlibmem <number>
1518 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1519 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1520 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001521 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1522 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1523 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525noepoll
1526 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1527 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001528 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529
1530nokqueue
1531 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1532 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1533 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1534
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001535noevports
1536 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1537 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1538 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1539 also "nopoll".
1540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541nopoll
1542 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1543 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001545 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1546 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001548nosplice
1549 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001551 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001552 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001553 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1554 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1555 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1556 "option splice-response".
1557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001558nogetaddrinfo
1559 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1560 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1561
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001562noreuseport
1563 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1564 command line argument "-dR".
1565
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001566profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1567 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1568 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1569 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1570 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001571 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001572 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1573 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1574 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1575 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1576
1577 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1578 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1579 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1580 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1581 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001582 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1583 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1584 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1585 CLI.
1586
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001587spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001588 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1589 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1590 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1591 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1592 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1593 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001596 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001597 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001598 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1599 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1600 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1601 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1602 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1604 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001605 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1606 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1607 openssl configuration file uses:
1608 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1609
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001610ssl-mode-async
1611 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001612 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001613 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1614 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1615 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001616 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001617 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001618
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001619tune.buffers.limit <number>
1620 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1621 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1622 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1623 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1624 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001626 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1627 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1628 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1629 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1630 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1631 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1632 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1633 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1634 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1635
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001636tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1637 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1638 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1639 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1640 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1641
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001642tune.bufsize <number>
1643 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1644 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1645 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1646 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1647 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1648 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1649 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001650 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1651 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1652 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001653 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001654 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1655 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1656 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001657
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001658tune.chksize <number>
1659 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1660 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1661 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1662 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1663 checks whenever possible.
1664
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001665tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1666 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1667 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1668 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1669 this value. The default value is 1.
1670
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001671tune.fail-alloc
1672 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1673 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1674 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1675 gracefully.
1676
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001677tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1678 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1679 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1680 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1681 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1682 change it.
1683
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001684tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1685 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001686 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1687 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001688 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1689 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1690 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1691 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1692 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1693
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001694tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1695 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1696 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1697 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1698 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1699 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1700 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1701 recommended not to change this value.
1702
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001703tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1704 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1705 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1706 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1707 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1708 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1709 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1710 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1711
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001712tune.http.cookielen <number>
1713 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1714 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1715 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1716 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1717 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1718 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1719 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1720 to change this value.
1721
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001722tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1724 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001725 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001727 configuration directives too.
1728 The default value is 1024.
1729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1738 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1739 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001740
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001741tune.idletimer <timeout>
1742 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1743 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1744 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1745 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1746 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1747 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001749 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001750 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1751
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001752tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1753 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1754 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1755 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1756 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1757 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1758 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1759 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1760 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1761 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1762
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001763tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1764 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001765 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1767 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001769 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1770 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1771
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001772tune.lua.maxmem
1773 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1774 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1775 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1776 memory.
1777
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001778tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1779 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001780 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1781 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001783
1784tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1785 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1786 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1787 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1788 check servers.
1789
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001790tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1791 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1792 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1793 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001795
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001796tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001797 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1798 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1799 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1800 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1801 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1802 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1803 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1804 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1805 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1806 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807
1808tune.maxpollevents <number>
1809 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1810 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1811 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1812 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1813 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1814
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001815tune.maxrewrite <number>
1816 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1817 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1818 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1819 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1820 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1821 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1822 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1823 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1824 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1825 bufsize.
1826
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001827tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1828 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1829 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1830 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1831 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1832 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1833 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1834 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1835 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1836 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001837 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1838 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001839 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1840 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1841 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1842 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1843 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1844 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1845 setting this parameter to 0.
1846
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001847tune.pipesize <number>
1848 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1849 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1850 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1851 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1852 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1853 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1854
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001855tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1856 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1857 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1858 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1859 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1860 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1861 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001862 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001863
Willy Tarreauc55e3e12020-07-01 18:30:16 +02001864tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1865 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1866 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1867 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1868 default is 20.
1869
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001870tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1871tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1872 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1873 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1874 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001875 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001877 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1878 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1879
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001880tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001881 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001882 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1883 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1884 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1885 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1886
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001887tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001888 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001889 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1890 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1893tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1895 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1902 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1903 notifying haproxy again.
1904
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001905tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001906 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1907 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1908 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001909 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001910 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001911 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001912 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1913 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1914 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001915 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1916 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001917
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001918tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001919 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001920 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1921 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1922 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1923 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1924 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1925
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001926tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1927 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001928 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001929 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1930 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1931 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1932 being used for too long.
1933
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001934tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1935 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1936 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1937 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1938 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1939 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1940 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1941 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1942 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1943 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1944 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001946 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001947
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001948tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1949 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1950 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1951 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1952 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1953 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1954 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1955 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1957 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001958
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001959tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1960 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1961 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1962 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1963 1000 entries.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001965tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1966 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1967 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1968 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001970tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001971tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001972tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1973tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001975 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1976 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1977 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1978 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1979 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1980 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1981 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1982 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001984 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1985 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1986 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1987 all available space is consumed.
1988 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1989 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1990 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001991
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001992tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1993 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001994 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001995 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001996 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001997 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1998
1999tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2000 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2001 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2003 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020053.3. Debugging
2006--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007
2008debug
2009 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2010 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2011 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2012 system startup.
2013
2014quiet
2015 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2016 line argument "-q".
2017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020193.4. Userlists
2020--------------
2021It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2022http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2023it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2024
2025userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002026 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002027 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2028
2029group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002030 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002031 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2032 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002034user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2035 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002036 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2037 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002038 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2039 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2040 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2041 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002043 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2044 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2045 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2046 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2047 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2048 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2049 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2050 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2051 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002052
2053 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002054 userlist L1
2055 group G1 users tiger,scott
2056 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002058 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2059 user scott insecure-password elgato
2060 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002062 userlist L2
2063 group G1
2064 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2067 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2068 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002069
2070 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072
20733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002074----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002075It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2076several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2077instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2078values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2079automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2080In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2081using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2082tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2083reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2084Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2085that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2086each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002087
2088peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002089 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002090 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2091
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002092bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2093 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2094 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2095
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002096disabled
2097 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2098 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2099 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2100
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002101default-bind [param*]
2102 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2103
2104default-server [param*]
2105 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2106
2107 Arguments:
2108 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2109 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2110 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2111 details.
2112
2113
2114 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2115
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002116enable
2117 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2118
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002119peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002120 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2121 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2122 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2123 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2124 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2125 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2126
2127 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2128 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2129
2130 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2131 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2132 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2133 across all peers.
2134
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2136 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002137
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002138 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2139 "server" keyword explanation below).
2140
2141server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002142 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002143 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2144 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2145 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2146 of this "peers" section).
2147 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2148
2149
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002150 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002151 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002156
2157 backend mybackend
2158 mode tcp
2159 balance roundrobin
2160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2161 stick on src
2162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Example:
2167 peers mypeers
2168 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2169 default-server ssl verify none
2170 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2171 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002172
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002173
2174table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2175 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2176
2177 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2178 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002179 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002180 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2181 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2182 "stick-table" keyword).
2183
2184 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2185 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2186 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2187 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2188 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2189 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2190 of the stick-table name as follows:
2191
2192 peers mypeers
2193 peer A ...
2194 peer B ...
2195 table t1 ...
2196
2197 frontend fe1
2198 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2199
2200 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2201 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2202
2203 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2204 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2205 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2206 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2207 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2208 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2209 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2210
2211 peers mypeers
2212 peer A ...
2213 peer B ...
2214 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2215
2216 backend t1
2217 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2218
2219 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2220 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2221 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2222
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022233.6. Mailers
2224------------
2225It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2226If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2227in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2228
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002229mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002230 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2231 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2232
2233mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2234 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2235
2236 Example:
2237 mailers mymailers
2238 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2239 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2240
2241 backend mybackend
2242 mode tcp
2243 balance roundrobin
2244
2245 email-alert mailers mymailers
2246 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2247 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2248
2249 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2250 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2251
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002252timeout mail <time>
2253 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2254 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2255 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2256 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2257
2258 Example:
2259 mailers mymailers
2260 timeout mail 20s
2261 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002262
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022633.7. Programs
2264-------------
2265In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2266master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2267managed the same way as the workers.
2268
2269During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2270sequence as a worker:
2271
2272 - the master is re-executed
2273 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2274 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2275 instance of the program
2276
2277During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2278
2279program <name>
2280 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2281 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2282 the management guide).
2283
2284command <command> [arguments*]
2285 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2286 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2287 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2288 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2289
2290option start-on-reload
2291no option start-on-reload
2292 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2293 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2294 program section.
2295
2296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002298----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002301 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002302 - frontend <name>
2303 - backend <name>
2304 - listen <name>
2305
2306A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2307its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2308section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
2311A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2312connections.
2313
2314A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2315to forward incoming connections.
2316
2317A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2318parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2321'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2322case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2323
2324Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2325logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2326proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2327However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2328name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2329
2330Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2331and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2334modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2335arbitrary criteria.
2336
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002337In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2338a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002339the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002340
2341 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2342 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2343 between responses and new requests.
2344
2345 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2346 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2347 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002348 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2349 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2350 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2351 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2354 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2355 client-facing connection remains open.
2356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002357 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2358 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2361frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2362following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002363weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002365 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002367 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2368 ----+-----+-----+----
2369 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2370 ----+-----+-----+----
2371 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2372 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2373 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2374 ----+-----+-----+----
2375 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2380--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002382The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2383limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2384they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2385limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002387option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002388and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2389with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2390specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002392
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002393 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2394------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2395acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396backlog X X X -
2397balance X - X X
2398bind - X X -
2399bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002400block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401capture cookie - X X -
2402capture request header - X X -
2403capture response header - X X -
2404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2407cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002408declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409default-server X - X X
2410default_backend X X X -
2411description - X X X
2412disabled X X X X
2413dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002414email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002415email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002416email-alert mailers X X X X
2417email-alert myhostname X X X X
2418email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419enabled X X X X
2420errorfile X X X X
2421errorloc X X X X
2422errorloc302 X X X X
2423-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2424errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002425force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002426filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427fullconn X - X X
2428grace X X X X
2429hash-type X - X X
2430http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002431http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002432http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002434http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002435http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002436http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002437id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002438ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002439load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002440log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002441log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002442log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002443log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002444max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445maxconn X X X -
2446mode X X X X
2447monitor fail - X X -
2448monitor-net X X X -
2449monitor-uri X X X -
2450option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2451option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2452option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2453option allbackups (*) X - X X
2454option checkcache (*) X - X X
2455option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2456option contstats (*) X X X -
2457option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2458option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2460option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002461option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002463option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002464option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002465option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002466option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002467option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002469option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002471option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472option httpchk X - X X
2473option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002474option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002475option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002476option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002477option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002478option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2480option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2481option logasap (*) X X X -
2482option mysql-check X - X X
2483option nolinger (*) X X X X
2484option originalto X X X X
2485option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002486option pgsql-check X - X X
2487option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002488option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002489option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490option smtpchk X - X X
2491option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2492option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2493option splice-request (*) X X X X
2494option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002495option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2497option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2498-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002499option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2501option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2502option tcpka X X X X
2503option tcplog X X X X
2504option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002505external-check command X - X X
2506external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2508rate-limit sessions X X X -
2509redirect - X X X
2510redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2511redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002512reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2513reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002524-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002525reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002527retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002528rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2529rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2534rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002535server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002536server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002537server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002538source X - X X
2539srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002540stats admin - X X X
2541stats auth X X X X
2542stats enable X X X X
2543stats hide-version X X X X
2544stats http-request - X X X
2545stats realm X X X X
2546stats refresh X X X X
2547stats scope X X X X
2548stats show-desc X X X X
2549stats show-legends X X X X
2550stats show-node X X X X
2551stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2553stick match - - X X
2554stick on - - X X
2555stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002556stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002557stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002558tcp-check connect - - X X
2559tcp-check expect - - X X
2560tcp-check send - - X X
2561tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002562tcp-request connection - X X -
2563tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002564tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002565tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002566tcp-response content - - X X
2567tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568timeout check X - X X
2569timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002570timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2572timeout connect X - X X
2573timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2574timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2575timeout http-request X X X X
2576timeout queue X - X X
2577timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002578timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2580timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002581timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002583unique-id-format X X X -
2584unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002586use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002587------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2588 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2592---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
2594This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2595
2596
2597acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2598 Declare or complete an access list.
2599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 no | yes | yes | yes
2601 Example:
2602 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2603 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2604 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
2608
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002609backlog <conns>
2610 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | yes | yes | no
2613 Arguments :
2614 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2615 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002616 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002617
2618 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2619 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2620 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2621 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2622 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2623 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2624 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2625 backlog parameter.
2626
2627 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2628 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2629 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2630
2631 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2632
2633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002635balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 yes | no | yes | yes
2639 Arguments :
2640 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2641 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2642 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2643 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2644
2645 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2646 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2647 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2648 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002649 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002650 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002651 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2652 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2653 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2654 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2655 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2656 it, so that you don't worry.
2657
2658 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2659 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2660 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2661 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2662 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2663 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2664 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2665 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002667 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2668 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2669 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2670 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2671 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2672 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2673 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2674 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2675
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002676 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002677 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002678 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2679 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002680 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002681 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2682 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2683 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2684 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2685 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002686 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2687 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2688 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2689 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2690 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2691 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2694 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2695 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2696 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2697 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2698 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2699 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2700 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002701 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002703 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2704 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2705 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002707 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2708 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2709 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2710 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2711 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2712 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2713 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2714 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2715 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2716 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2717 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2718 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002720 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002721 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2722 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2723 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2724 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2725 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2726 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2727 URIs start with a leading "/".
2728
2729 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2730 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2731 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2732 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002735 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2736
2737 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002738 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2739 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002740 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2741 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2742 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2743 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002744 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002745 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2746 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002747
2748 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2749 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2750 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2751 server will receive the request.
2752
2753 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2754 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2755 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2756 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2757 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002758 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2759 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2760 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002762 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2763 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2764 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2765 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2766 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002768 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002769 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2770 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2771 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2772
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002773 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2774 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2775 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2776
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002777 random
2778 random(<draws>)
2779 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002780 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2781 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2782 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2783 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002784 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2785 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2786 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2787 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2788 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2789 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2790 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2791 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2792 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2793 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2794 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2795 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2796 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2797 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2798 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2799 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2800 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2801 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2802 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2803 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002804
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002805 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002806 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002807 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2808 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2809 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2810 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2811 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2812 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002813 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002814 used instead.
2815
2816 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2817 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2818 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2819 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2820
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002821 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2822 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2823 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2824
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002825 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002828 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2829 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002830
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002831 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2832 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2833 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002835 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002836 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002837 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2838 NTLM relies on.
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840 Examples :
2841 balance roundrobin
2842 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002843 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002844 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2845 balance hdr(host)
2846 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002847
2848 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2849 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002851 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002852 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2853 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2854 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2855 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2856
2857 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2858 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2859 defaults to 16 kB.
2860
2861 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2862 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2863
2864 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2865 Round Robin.
2866
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002867 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002868 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2869 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2870 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2871
2872 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2873
2874 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002875 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002876 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2877 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2878 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002880 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
2882
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002883bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2884bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 no | yes | yes | no
2888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002889 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2890 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2891 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2892 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002893 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002894 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2895 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2896 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2897 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2902 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2903 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2904 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2905 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2906 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2907 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002908 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2909 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2910 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002911 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2912 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2913 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2914 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002915 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2916 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2917 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002918
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002919 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2920 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002921 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2922 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2923 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002924 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2925 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2926 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2927 the range.
2928
2929 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2930 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2931 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2932 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2933 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2934 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2935 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002936 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002937 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002939 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002940 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002941 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2942 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2943 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2944 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2945 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2946 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002948 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2949 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2950 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2951 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2954 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2955 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2956 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2957 in a frontend.
2958
2959 Example :
2960 listen http_proxy
2961 bind :80,:443
2962 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002963 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002965 listen http_https_proxy
2966 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002967 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002968
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002969 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2970 bind ipv6@:80
2971 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2972 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2973
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002974 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002975 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002976
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002977 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2978 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2979 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2980 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2981 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002983 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002984 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985
2986
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002987bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002988 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | yes
2991 Arguments :
2992 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2993 may be used to override a default value.
2994
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002995 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002996 option may be combined with other numbers.
2997
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002998 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002999 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3000 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3001 missing from all processes.
3002
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003003 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003004 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003005 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3006 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3007 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3008 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3009 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003010 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003011
3012 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3013 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3014 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3015 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3016 and 'even' instances.
3017
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003018 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3019 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3020 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3021 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003022
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003023 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3024 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3025
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003026 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3027 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3028 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3029
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003030 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3031 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3032
3033 Example :
3034 listen app_ip1
3035 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003036 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003037
3038 listen app_ip2
3039 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003040 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003041
3042 listen management
3043 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003044 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003045
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003046 listen management
3047 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3048 bind-process 1-4
3049
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003050 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003051
3052
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003053block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 no | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3059 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003060 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003061 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003063 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3064 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3065 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003067 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3068 "http-request deny" instead.
3069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 Example:
3071 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3072 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3073 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003074 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3075 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3076 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003078 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3079 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3080 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081
3082capture cookie <name> len <length>
3083 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
3087 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3088 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3089 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3090 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003091 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092
3093 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3094 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3095 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3096 right if it exceeds <length>.
3097
3098 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3099 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3100 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3101 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3102
3103 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3104 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3105 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3106
3107 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3108 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3109 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003110 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3111 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3112 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113
3114 Example:
3115 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3116
3117 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003118 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119
3120
3121capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003122 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 no | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments :
3126 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003127 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3129 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3130 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3131
3132 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3133 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3134 it exceeds <length>.
3135
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003136 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3138 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003139 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3140 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3141 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3142 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003143 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003144 environments to find where the request came from.
3145
3146 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3147 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3148 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3149 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003151 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3152 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3153 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3154 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3155 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
3157 Example:
3158 capture request header Host len 15
3159 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003160 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163 about logging.
3164
3165
3166capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003167 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 no | yes | yes | no
3170 Arguments :
3171 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003172 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3174 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3175 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3176
3177 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3178 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3179 it exceeds <length>.
3180
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003181 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3183 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3184 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003185 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3186 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3187 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3188 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003190 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3191 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3192 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3193 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3194 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195
3196 Example:
3197 capture response header Content-length len 9
3198 capture response header Location len 15
3199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003200 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201 about logging.
3202
3203
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003204clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | no
3208 Arguments :
3209 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3211 as explained at the top of this document.
3212
3213 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3215 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3216 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3217 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3218 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3219 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3220 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003221 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003223 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
3225 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3226 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3227 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3228 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3229 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3230 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3231
3232 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3233 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3234
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003235 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3236 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003238compression algo <algorithm> ...
3239compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003240compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003241 Enable HTTP compression.
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003245 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3246 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3247 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3248
3249 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003250 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3251 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3252 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003253
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003254 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003255 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003256
3257 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3258 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3259 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3260 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3261 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003262 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003263
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003264 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3265 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3266 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3267 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3268 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3269 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3270 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003271 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003272
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003273 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003274 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003275 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3276 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3277 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3278 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3279 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003280
3281 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3282 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3283 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3284 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3285 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003286 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3287 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3288 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3289 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3290 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003291 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3292 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003293
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003294 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003295 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3296 "Accept-Encoding" header
3297 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003298 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003299 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3300 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3301 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3302 "multipart"
3303 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3304 header
3305 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3306 and later
3307 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3308 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003309 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003310
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003311 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003312
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003313 Examples :
3314 compression algo gzip
3315 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003317
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003318contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | no | yes | yes
3322 Arguments :
3323 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3325 as explained at the top of this document.
3326
3327 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003328 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003329 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3332 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3333 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3334
3335 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3336 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3337 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3338 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3339 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3340 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3341
3342 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3343 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3344 instead.
3345
3346 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3347 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3348
3349
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003350cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003351 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3352 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003353 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | no | yes | yes
3357 Arguments :
3358 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3359 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3360 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3361 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3362 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3363 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003365 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3366 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3367
3368 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3369 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3370 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3371 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3372 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3373 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003374 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3375 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003377 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3378 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
3380 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003381 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003382
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003383 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003385 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3388 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3389 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3390 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3391 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3392 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3393 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394
3395 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3396 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3397 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3398 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3399 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3400 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3401 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3402 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3403 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003404 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003405 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3406 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3407 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003409 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3410 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3411 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003412 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3413 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3414 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3415 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003416 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3417 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3418 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
3420 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3421 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3422 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3423 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3424 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3425 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3426 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3427 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3428 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3429
3430 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3431 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3432 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3433 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3434 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3435 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3436 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3437 persistence cookie in the cache.
3438 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3439
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003440 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3441 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3442 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3443 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3444 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003445 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003446 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3447 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3448 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3449 they logout.
3450
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003451 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3452 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3453 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3454 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3455
3456 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3457 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3458 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3459 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3460 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3461 this attribute.
3462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003463 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003464 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003465 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3466 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3467 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3468 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3469 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3470 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003471
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003472 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3473 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3474 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3475 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3476 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3477 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3478 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3479 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003480 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003481 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3482 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3483 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3484 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3485 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3486 the site.
3487
3488 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3489 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3490 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3491 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3492 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3493 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3494 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3495 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3496 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3497 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3498 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3499 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3500 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003501 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003502 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3503 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3504
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003505 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3506 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3507 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3508 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3509 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3510 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3511
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003512 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3513 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3514 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3515 repeated.
3516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3518 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3519 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3520 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522 Examples :
3523 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3524 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3525 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003526 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003528 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003530
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003531declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3532 Declares a capture slot.
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 no | yes | yes | no
3535 Arguments:
3536 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3537
3538 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3539 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3540 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3541 for use in the response.
3542
3543 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003544 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003545 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3546
3547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003548default-server [param*]
3549 Change default options for a server in a backend
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003553 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3554 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3555 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3556 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003557
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003558 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003559 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3560
3561 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564default_backend <backend>
3565 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | no
3568 Arguments :
3569 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3570
3571 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3572 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3573 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3574 will catch all undetermined requests.
3575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576 Example :
3577
3578 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3579 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3580 default_backend dynamic
3581
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003582 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003585description <string>
3586 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3588 no | yes | yes | yes
3589 Arguments : string
3590
3591 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3592 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3593 it describes.
3594 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3595
3596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003597disabled
3598 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601 Arguments : none
3602
3603 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3604 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3605 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3606 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3607 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3608 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3609 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3610
3611 See also : "enabled"
3612
3613
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614dispatch <address>:<port>
3615 Set a default server address
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003619
3620 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3621 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3622 during start-up.
3623
3624 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3625 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3626 possible with normal servers.
3627
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003628 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003629 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3630 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3631 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3632 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3633
3634 See also : "server"
3635
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003636
3637dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3638 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | no | yes | yes
3641 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3642
3643 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003644 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003645 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3646 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003648 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650enabled
3651 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments : none
3655
3656 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3657 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3658
3659 See also : "disabled"
3660
3661
3662errorfile <code> <file>
3663 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666 Arguments :
3667 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003668 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3669 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670
3671 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003672 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003674 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3675 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676
3677 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3678 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3679 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3680
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003681 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3684 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3685 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3686 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3689 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003690 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3692 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3693 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3696 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3697 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003698 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3700
3701 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3702
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003703 Example :
3704 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003705 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003706 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3707 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3708
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003709
3710errorloc <code> <url>
3711errorloc302 <code> <url>
3712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | yes
3715 Arguments :
3716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003717 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3718 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003719
3720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003725
3726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3734 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3735 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003736 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003737 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3738 request.
3739
3740 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3741
3742
3743errorloc303 <code> <url>
3744 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | yes | yes | yes
3747 Arguments :
3748 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003749 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3750 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003751
3752 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3753 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3754 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3755 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003757
3758 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3759 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3760 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3761
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003762 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3763
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3765 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3766 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3767 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003768 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3771
3772
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773email-alert from <emailaddr>
3774 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003775 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778
3779 Arguments :
3780
3781 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3782
3783 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3784 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003786 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3788 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003789
3790
3791email-alert level <level>
3792 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3793 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | yes | yes | yes
3796
3797 Arguments :
3798
3799 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3800 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3801 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3802
3803 By default level is alert
3804
3805 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3806 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3807 for the proxy.
3808
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003809 Alerts are sent when :
3810
3811 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3812 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3813 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3814 is notice or lower
3815 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3816 and a health check status update occurs
3817
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003818 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3819 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003820 section 3.6 about mailers.
3821
3822
3823email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3824 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827
3828 Arguments :
3829
3830 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3831
3832 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3833 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3834
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003835 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3836 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003837
3838
3839email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3840 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3841 mailers.
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | yes
3844
3845 Arguments :
3846
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003847 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003848
3849 By default the systems hostname is used.
3850
3851 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3852 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3853 for the proxy.
3854
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003855 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3856 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003857
3858
3859email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | yes | yes | yes
3864
3865 Arguments :
3866
3867 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3868
3869 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3870 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3871
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003872 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003873 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3874
3875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003876force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3877 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003879 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003880
3881 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3882 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3883 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3884 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3885 marked down for maintenance operations.
3886
3887 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3888 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3889 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3890 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3891 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3892 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3893 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3894 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3895 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3896
3897 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3898 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3899 is used.
3900
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003901 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003902 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003903
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003904
3905filter <name> [param*]
3906 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 no | yes | yes | yes
3909 Arguments :
3910 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3911 referenced in section 9.
3912
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003913 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003914 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003915 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3916 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3919 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3920
3921 Example:
3922 listen
3923 bind *:80
3924
3925 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3926 filter compression
3927 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3928
3929 compression algo gzip
3930 compression offload
3931
3932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3933
3934 See also : section 9.
3935
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003936
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003937fullconn <conns>
3938 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | no | yes | yes
3941 Arguments :
3942 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3943 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3944
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003945 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003946 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003947 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003948 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3949 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3950 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3951 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3952 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003953 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003955 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3956 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003957 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3958 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3959 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 Example :
3962 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3963 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3964 # connections.
3965 backend dynamic
3966 fullconn 10000
3967 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3968 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969
3970 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3971
3972
3973grace <time>
3974 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977 Arguments :
3978 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3979 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3980 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3981
3982 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3983 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003984 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3986
3987 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3988 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3989 simplify it.
3990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003992hash-balance-factor <factor>
3993 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | no | no | yes
3996 Arguments :
3997 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3998 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003999 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004000
4001 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4002 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4003 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4004 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4005 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4006 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4007 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4008
4009 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4010 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4011 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4012 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4013 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4014
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004015 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4016 consistent hashing mechanism.
4017
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004018 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4019
4020
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004021hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004026 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4027 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004029 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4030 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4031 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4032 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4033 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4034 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4035 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4036 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4037 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4038 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004039
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004040 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4041 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4042 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4043 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4044 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4045 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4046 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4047 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4048 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4049 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4050 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4051 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4052 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004053 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4054 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004055
4056 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4057
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004058 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004059 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4060 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4061 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004062 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4063 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4064 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004065
4066 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4067 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004068 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4069 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4070 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4071 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4072
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004073 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4074 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4075 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4076 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4077 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4078 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4079 parameter.
4080
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004081 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4082 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4083 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4084 used on strings.
4085
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004086 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4087
4088 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4089 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4090 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4091 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4092 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4093 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4094 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4095 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4096 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4097 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4098 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4099 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004100
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004101 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4102 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4103 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004104
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004105 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004106
4107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108http-check disable-on-404
4109 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112 Arguments : none
4113
4114 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4115 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4116 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4117 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4118 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4119 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4120 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4121 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004122 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4123 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4124 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4125
4126 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4127
4128
4129http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004130 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004133 Arguments :
4134 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4135 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004136 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004137 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4138 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4139 details on the supported keywords.
4140
4141 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4142 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4143 with the usual backslash ('\').
4144
4145 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4146 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4147 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4148 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4149 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4150
4151 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004152 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004153 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4154 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4155 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4156
4157 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004159 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4160 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4161 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4162 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4163
4164 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4167 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4169 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4170 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004171 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 trace).
4173
4174 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004175 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004176 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4177 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4178 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4179 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4180 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004181 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004182
4183 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4184 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4185 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4186 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4187 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4188 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4189 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4190 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4191
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004192 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4193 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4194 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4195
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004196 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4197 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4198
4199 Examples :
4200 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004201 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004202
4203 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004204 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004205
4206 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004207 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004208
4209 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004210 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004212 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213
4214
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004215http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4216 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4217 health checks.
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments :
4221 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4222 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4223 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4224
4225 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4226 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4227 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4228 to the request.
4229
4230 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4231 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4232 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4233 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4234 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4235 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4236 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4237 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4238
4239 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4240
4241
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004242http-check send-state
4243 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | no | yes | yes
4246 Arguments : none
4247
4248 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4249 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4250 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4251 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4252 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4253
4254 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4255 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4256 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4257 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4258 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004259 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4260 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4261 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4262
4263 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4264 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4265 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4266
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004267 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4268 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4269 checked in multiple backends.
4270
4271 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4272 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4273
4274 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4275 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4276 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4277 one fails.
4278
4279 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4280 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4281 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4282
4283 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4284 server's queue.
4285
4286 Example of a header received by the application server :
4287 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4288 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4289
4290 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292
4293http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004294 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4295
4296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 no | yes | yes | yes
4298
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004299 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4300 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4301 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4302 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4303 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4306 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4311 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4312 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4313 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4316 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4317 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4318 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 Example:
4321 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4322 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4323 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 http-request allow if nagios
4326 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4327 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4328 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Example:
4331 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4332 acl add path /addacl
4333 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4338 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 Example:
4341 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4342 acl setmap path /setmap
4343 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4348 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4351 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4356 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4357 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4358 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4359 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4360 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4361 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4362 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4367 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4368 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4369 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4370 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4371 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4372 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4373 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4378 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004379
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4384 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4385 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4386 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4387 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 Example:
4390 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4391 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004392
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004393http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4401 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4402 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4403 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4404 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4405 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4406 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4407 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4408 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4411 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4412 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004413 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4414
4415 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4416 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4417 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4418 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4423 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4424 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4425 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4426 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4427 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4436 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4437 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4438 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4439 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4440 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4445 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4446 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4447 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4448 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004449
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004450http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4451 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4452 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4453 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4454
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004455http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4456
4457 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4458 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4459 pointed by <resolvers>.
4460 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4461 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4462 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4463 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4464 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4465 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4466 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4467 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4468 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4469 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4470 to 0.0.0.0.
4471
4472 Example:
4473 resolvers mydns
4474 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4475 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4476 timeout retry 1s
4477 hold valid 10s
4478 hold nx 3s
4479 hold other 3s
4480 hold obsolete 0s
4481 accepted_payload_size 8192
4482
4483 frontend fe
4484 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4485 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4486 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4487
4488 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4489 # which mean DNS resolution error
4490 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4491
4492 default_backend be
4493
4494 backend b_503
4495 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4496 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4497 # 503 error page to end users
4498
4499 backend be
4500 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4501 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4502 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4503 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4504 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4505
4506 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4507 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4508
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004509http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4510
4511 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4512 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4513 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4514 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004515 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4516 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004517
4518 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4523 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4524 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4525 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4526 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4531 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4532 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4533 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4536 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004537
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004538 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004539 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4540 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4541 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4542 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4543 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004544
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004545 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4546 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4547 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4548 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4549 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004550
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004551 Example:
4552 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4553
4554 # applied to:
4555 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4556
4557 # outputs:
4558 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4559
4560 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004561
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004562 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4563
4564 # applied to:
4565 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004566
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004567 # outputs:
4568 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004569
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004570http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4572
4573 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4574 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet99721282020-09-02 14:16:59 +02004575 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
4576 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
4577 query-string.
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004578
4579 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4580 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4581 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4582
4583 Example:
4584 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4585 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4586
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004587 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4588 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4589 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4590 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4591
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004592http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4593 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4594
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004595 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4596 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4597 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4598 against.
4599
4600 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4601 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4602 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004603
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004604 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4605 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4606 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4607 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4608 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4609 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4610 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4611 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4612 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004613 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4614 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004615
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004616 Example:
4617 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4618 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004619
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004620 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4621 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4624 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004625
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004626 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4627 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4628 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4629 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004630
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004631 Example:
4632 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004633
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004634 # applied to:
4635 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004636
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004637 # outputs:
4638 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4641http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4644 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4645 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4650 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4651 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4656 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4657 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4658 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4659 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661 Arguments:
4662 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4663 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 Example:
4666 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4667 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4670 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4675 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4676 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678 Arguments:
4679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4680 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682 Example:
4683 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4684 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4687 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4688 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4693 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4694 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4695 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4696 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 Example:
4699 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4700 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4701 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4702 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4712 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4713 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4714 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4715 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4718 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004720 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4721 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4722 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4723 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4724 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4725 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4726 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4727 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4728 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004730http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004732 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4733 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4734 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4735 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4736 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4737 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4738 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004740http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4743 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4744 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4749 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4750 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4751 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4752 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4753 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4754 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4755 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4760 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4761 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4762 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4763 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4764 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004766 Example :
4767 # prepend the host name before the path
4768 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004770http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004772 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4773 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4774 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4775 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4776 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004778http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004780 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4781 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4782 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4783 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4784 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4785 values have higher priority.
4786 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4787 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4788 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4789 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4790 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004792http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4795 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4796 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4797 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4798 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4799 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4800 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004802 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004803
4804 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4806 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004808http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4810 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4811 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004812 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4813 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004814
4815 Arguments :
4816 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4817 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004818
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004819 See also "option forwardfor".
4820
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004821 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004822 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4823 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4824
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004825 # After the masking this will track connections
4826 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4827 http-request track-sc0 src
4828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004829 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4830 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4831
4832http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4833
4834 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4835 expression.
4836
4837 Arguments:
4838 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4839 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004840
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004841 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004842 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4843 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4844
4845 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4846 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4847 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4848
4849http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4850
4851 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4852 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4853 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4854 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4855 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4856 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4857 information from the request.
4858
4859 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4860
4861http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4862
4863 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4864 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4865 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4866 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4867 path and the query string.
4868 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4869
4870http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4871
4872 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4873 inline.
4874
4875 Arguments:
4876 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4877 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4880 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4881 (request and response)
4882 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4883 processing
4884 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4885 processing
4886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4887 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4888 and '_'.
4889
4890 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4891 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004892
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004893 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004894 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004896http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4900 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4901 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4902 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4903 agent name must be used.
4904
4905 Arguments:
4906 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4907
4908 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4909 configuration.
4910
4911http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4912
4913 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4914 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4915 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4916 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4917 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4918 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4919 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4920 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4921 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4922 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4923 action.
4924 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4925 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4926 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4927 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4928 you fully understand how it works.
4929
4930http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931
4932 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4933 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4934 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4935 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4936 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4937 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4938 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4939 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4940 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4941 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4942 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4943 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4944 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4945
4946http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4947http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4949
4950 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4951 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4952 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4953 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4954 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4955 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4956 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4957 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4958 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4959 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4960 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4961 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4962
4963 Arguments :
4964 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4965 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4966 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4967 select which table entry to update the counters.
4968
4969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4970 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4971 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4972 that table until the session ends.
4973
4974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4975 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4976 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4977 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4978 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4979 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4980 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4981 useful information.
4982
4983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4984 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4985 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4986 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4987 checks that make use of it.
4988
4989http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
4993 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004994 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004995
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004996http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4999 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5000 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5001 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5002 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5003 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5004
5005 Arguments :
5006 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5007
5008 Example:
5009 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005011http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5014 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5015 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005016
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005019 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5020
5021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 no | yes | yes | yes
5023
5024 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5025 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5026 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5027 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5028 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5029 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5032 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5037 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5038 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5039 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5042 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5043 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5044 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 Example:
5047 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5052 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 Example:
5055 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5060 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5063 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5068 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5069 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5070 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5071 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5072 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5073 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5074 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5079 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5080 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5081 example, or to pass some internal information.
5082 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5083 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5084 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005086http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5089 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005090
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005091http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005093 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5098 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5099 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5100 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5101 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5102 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5103 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5106 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5107 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5108 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5109 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005110
5111 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5112 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5113 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5114 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5119 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5120 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5121 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5122 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5123 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005127 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005129http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5134 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5135 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5136 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005138http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5141 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5146 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5147 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5148 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5149 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5150 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005152http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005154
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005155 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5156 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005158 Example:
5159 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161 # applied to:
5162 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 # outputs:
5165 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005171
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005172 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5173 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005175 Example:
5176 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005178 # applied to:
5179 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005181 # outputs:
5182 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5188 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5189 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005191http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005193 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5194 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5195 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005197http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005199 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5200 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5201 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5202 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5203 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 Arguments:
5206 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005208 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5209 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005211http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5214 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5215 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005217http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5218
5219 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5220 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5221 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5222 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5223 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5224
5225http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5226
5227 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5228 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5229 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5230 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5231 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5232 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5233 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5234 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5235 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5236
5237http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238
5239 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5240 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5241 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5242 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5243 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5244 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5245 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5246
5247http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5248
5249 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5250 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5251 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5252 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5253 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5254 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5255 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5256 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5257
5258http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5259 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5260
5261 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5262 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5263 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5264 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005265
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005266 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005267 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5268 http-response set-status 431
5269 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5270 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005272http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005274 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5275 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5276 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5277 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5278 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5279 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5280 based on some information from the request.
5281
5282 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5283
5284http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5287 inline.
5288
5289 Arguments:
5290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5295 (request and response)
5296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5297 processing
5298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5299 processing
5300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5301 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5302 and '_'.
5303
5304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5305 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005306
5307 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005308 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005309
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005310http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005312 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5313 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5314 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5315 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5316 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5317 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5318 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5319 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5320 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5321 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5322 action.
5323 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5324 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5325 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5326 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5327 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005329http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005333 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5334 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5335 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5336 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5337 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5338 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5339
5340http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5341
5342 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5343 about <var-name>.
5344
5345 Example:
5346 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5347
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005348
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005349http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5350 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5351
5352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5353 yes | no | yes | yes
5354
5355 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005356 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5357 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5358 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005359
5360 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5361
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005362 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5363 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5364 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5365 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5366 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5367 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5368 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5369 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5370 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5371 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005372
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005373 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5374 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5375 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5376 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5377 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5378 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5379 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5380 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005381
5382 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5383 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5384 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5385 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5386 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5387 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5388 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5389 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005390 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005391 downsides of rare connection failures.
5392
5393 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5394 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5395 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5396 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5397 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5398 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005399 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005400 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5401 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5402 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5403 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5404 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5405
5406 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005407 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5408 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5409 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005410
5411 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005412 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005413
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005414 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5415 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005416
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005417 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005418
5419 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5420 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5421 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5422
5423 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5424
5425
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005426http-send-name-header [<header>]
5427 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005430 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005431 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5432
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005433 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5434 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5435 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5436 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5437 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5438 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5439 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5440 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5441 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5442 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5443 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5444 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5445 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5446 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5447 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5448 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005449
5450 See also : "server"
5451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005452id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005453 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | yes | yes | yes
5456 Arguments : none
5457
5458 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5459 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5460 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005461
5462
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005463ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5464 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005466 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005467
5468 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5469 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5470 and running).
5471
5472 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5473 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5474 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005475 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005476 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5477
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005478 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5479 "unless" condition is met.
5480
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005481 Example:
5482 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5483 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5484 ignore-persist if url_static
5485
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005486 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5487
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005488load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5489 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5490 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5491 yes | no | yes | yes
5492
5493 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5494 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5495 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005497 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5498 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5499 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5500 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005502 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005503 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005504 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005505
5506 Arguments:
5507 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5508 named "server-state-file".
5509
5510 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5511 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5512 name is used as a file name.
5513
5514 none don't load any stat for this backend
5515
5516 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005517 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5518 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5519 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005520 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005521 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005522
5523 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5524 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5525
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005526 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005527
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005528 global
5529 stats socket /tmp/socket
5530 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005531
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005532 defaults
5533 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005535 backend bk
5536 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5537 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005538
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005539
5540 Then one can run :
5541
5542 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5543
5544 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5545
5546 1
5547 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5548 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5549 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5550
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005551 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005552
5553 global
5554 stats socket /tmp/socket
5555 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5556
5557 defaults
5558 load-server-state-from-file local
5559
5560 backend bk
5561 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5562 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005564
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005565 Then one can run :
5566
5567 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5568
5569 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5570
5571 1
5572 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5573 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5574 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5575
5576 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5577 "show servers state"
5578
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005580log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005581log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5582 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005583no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005587
5588 Prefix :
5589 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5590 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5591 prefix does not allow arguments.
5592
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005593 Arguments :
5594 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5595 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5596 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5597 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5598 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5599 parameter.
5600
5601 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5602 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5603
5604 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5605 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5606 standard syslog port).
5607
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005608 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5609 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5610 standard syslog port).
5611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005612 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5613 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5614 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005615 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005616
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005617 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5618 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5619 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5620 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5621 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5622 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5623 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5624 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5625 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5626 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5627 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5628 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5629 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5630 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5631 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5632 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005633 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5634 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005635
5636 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5637 and "fd@2", see above.
5638
5639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5640 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005641
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005642 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5643 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5644 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5645 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5646 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5647 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5648 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5649 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5650 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5651 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005652 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005653
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005654 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5655 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5656 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5657 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5658 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5659
5660 <sample_size>
5661 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5662 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5663 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5664 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5665 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5666
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005667 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5668 one of the following :
5669
5670 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5671 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5672
5673 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5674 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5675
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005676 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5677 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5678 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5679 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5680 systemd logger consumes.
5681
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005682 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5683 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5684 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5685 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005687 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5688
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005689 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5690 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5691 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5692
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005693 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5694 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5695 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5696 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697
5698 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5699 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5700 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005701 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5702 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5703 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5704 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5705 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706
5707 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5708
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005709 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5710 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5711 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005712
5713 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5714 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5715 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5716 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5717
5718 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5719 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005720
5721 Example :
5722 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005723 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5724 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5725 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005726 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5727 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005731log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005732 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005735
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005736 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5737 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5738 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5739 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5740 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005741
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005742 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5743 "option httplog" directives.
5744
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005745log-format-sd <string>
5746 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | yes | yes | no
5749
5750 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5751 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5752 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5753 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5754 which covers the log format string in depth.
5755
5756 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5757 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5758
5759 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5760 log format to "rfc5424".
5761
5762 Example :
5763 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5764
5765
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005766log-tag <string>
5767 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | yes | yes | yes
5770
5771 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5772 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5773 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5774 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5775 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5776 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5777 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5778 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5779 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005780
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005781max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5782 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 yes | no | yes | yes
5785
5786 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5787 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5788 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5789 servers.
5790
5791 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5792 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5793 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5794 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5795 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005796 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005797 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5798 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5799 picking a different server.
5800
5801 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5802 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5803 even if they have to be queued.
5804
5805 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5806 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5807
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005808max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5809 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5810 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5811 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005813maxconn <conns>
5814 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 yes | yes | yes | no
5817 Arguments :
5818 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5819 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5820 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5821 closes.
5822
5823 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5824 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5825 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5826 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005827 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5828 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5829 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5830 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005831
5832 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5833 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5834 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5835
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005836 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5837 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005839 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5840
5841
5842mode { tcp|http|health }
5843 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 yes | yes | yes | yes
5846 Arguments :
5847 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5848 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5849 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5850 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5851
5852 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5853 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5854 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5855 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5856 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5857
5858 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005859 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5860 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5861 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5862 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5863 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5864 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5865 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005867 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5868 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5869 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005871 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872 defaults http_instances
5873 mode http
5874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005875 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005877
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005878monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005879 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882 Arguments :
5883 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5884 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005885 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005886 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5887 backend and its backup.
5888
5889 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5890 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5891 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5892 servers in a list of backends.
5893
5894 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5895 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5896 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5897 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5898 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5899 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5900 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005901 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5902 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005903
5904 Example:
5905 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005906 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005907 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5908 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5909 monitor-uri /site_alive
5910 monitor fail if site_dead
5911
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005912 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005913
5914
5915monitor-net <source>
5916 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | yes | yes | no
5919 Arguments :
5920 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5921 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5922 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5923 followed by a mask.
5924
5925 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5926 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005927 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005928 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5929
5930 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5931 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5932 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5933 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005934 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5935 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5936 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005937
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005938 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5939 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5940 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5941 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5942 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5943 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005944
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005945 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5946 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005947
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005948 Example :
5949 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5950 frontend www
5951 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5952
5953 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5954
5955
5956monitor-uri <uri>
5957 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 yes | yes | yes | no
5960 Arguments :
5961 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5962 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5963
5964 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5965 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5966 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5967 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5968 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5969 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5970 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5971 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5972
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005973 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5974 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5975 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5976 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5977 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5978 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5979 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5980 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005981
5982 Example :
5983 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5984 frontend www
5985 mode http
5986 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5987
5988 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005990
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005991option abortonclose
5992no option abortonclose
5993 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5995 yes | no | yes | yes
5996 Arguments : none
5997
5998 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5999 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6000 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6001 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006002 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6004 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6005 encountered while delivering the response.
6006
6007 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6008 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6009 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6010 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6011 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6012 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006014 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006015 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6017 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6018 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006020 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6021 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006022 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6023 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6024 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6025 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6026 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6027 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006028 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029
6030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6032
6033 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6034
6035
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006036option accept-invalid-http-request
6037no option accept-invalid-http-request
6038 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6040 yes | yes | yes | no
6041 Arguments : none
6042
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006043 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006044 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006045 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006046 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6047 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6048 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6049 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6050 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006051 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6052 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6053 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6054 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006055 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006056 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006057 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6058 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6059 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006060
6061 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6062 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6063 been confirmed.
6064
6065 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6066 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006067 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6068 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006069 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6070
6071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6073
6074 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6075 stats socket.
6076
6077
6078option accept-invalid-http-response
6079no option accept-invalid-http-response
6080 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083 Arguments : none
6084
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006085 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006086 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006087 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006088 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6089 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6090 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6091 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6092 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006093 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6094 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6095 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006096
6097 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6098 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6099 been confirmed.
6100
6101 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6102 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6103 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6104 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6105
6106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6108
6109 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6110 stats socket.
6111
6112
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006113option allbackups
6114no option allbackups
6115 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | no | yes | yes
6118 Arguments : none
6119
6120 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6121 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6122 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6123 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6124 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6125 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6126 order between the backup servers anymore.
6127
6128 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6129 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6130
6131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6133
6134
6135option checkcache
6136no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006137 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6139 yes | no | yes | yes
6140 Arguments : none
6141
6142 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6143 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006144 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006145 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6146 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006147 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006148
6149 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006150 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006151 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006152 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6153 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006154 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006155 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006156 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6157 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006158 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006159 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6160 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006161 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006162 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6163 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6165 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6170 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6171
6172 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006173 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006174 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006175 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006176 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6177
6178 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6179 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006180 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006181 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006182
6183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6185
6186
6187option clitcpka
6188no option clitcpka
6189 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6191 yes | yes | yes | no
6192 Arguments : none
6193
6194 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6195 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006196 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006197 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6198
6199 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6200 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6201 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6202 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6203
6204 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6205 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6206 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6207 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6208 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6209
6210 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6211
6212 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6213 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6214 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6215
6216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6218
6219 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6220
6221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006222option contstats
6223 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6225 yes | yes | yes | no
6226 Arguments : none
6227
6228 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6229 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6230 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6231 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006232 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6233 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6234 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6235 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6236 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006237
6238
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006239option dontlog-normal
6240no option dontlog-normal
6241 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | no
6244 Arguments : none
6245
6246 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6247 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6248 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6249 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6250 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6251 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6252 logged.
6253
6254 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6255 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6256 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006259 logging.
6260
6261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006262option dontlognull
6263no option dontlognull
6264 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | no
6267 Arguments : none
6268
6269 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6270 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6271 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6272 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6273 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6274 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006275 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6276 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6277 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006278
6279 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006280 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006281 would not be logged.
6282
6283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6285
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006286 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006288
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006289
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006290option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006291 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments :
6295 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6296 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006297 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006298 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006299
6300 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6301 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6302 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6303 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6304 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6305 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6306 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006307 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6308 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6309 possible that the client has already brought one.
6310
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006311 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006312 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006313 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006314 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006315 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006316 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006317
6318 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6319 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6320 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6321 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6322 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6323 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6324 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6325
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006326 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6327 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6328 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6329 are under the control of the end-user.
6330
Christopher Faulet313fa092021-04-06 09:01:09 +02006331 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
6332 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
6333
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006334 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006335 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6336 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006337 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6338 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6339 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006341 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006342 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6343 frontend www
6344 mode http
6345 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6346
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006347 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6348 backend www
6349 mode http
6350 option forwardfor header X-Client
6351
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006352 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006353 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006354
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006355
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006356option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6357no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6358 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | no
6361 Arguments : none
6362
6363 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6364 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6365 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6366 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6367 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6368 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6369 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6370
6371 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6372 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6373 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6374 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6375 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6376 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6377 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6378 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6379 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6380 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6381
6382 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6383
6384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6386
6387 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6388 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6389
6390
6391option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6392no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6393 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | no | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
6398 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6399 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6400 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6401 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6402 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6403 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6404 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6405
6406 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6407 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6408 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6409 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6410 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6411 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6412 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6413 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6414 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6415 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6416
6417 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6418
6419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6421
6422 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6423 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6424
6425
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006426option http-buffer-request
6427no option http-buffer-request
6428 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6434 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6435 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6436 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6437 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6438 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6439 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6440 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006441 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006442 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6443 default.
6444
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006445 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006446
6447
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006448option http-ignore-probes
6449no option http-ignore-probes
6450 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6452 yes | yes | yes | no
6453 Arguments : none
6454
6455 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6456 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6457 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6458 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6459 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6460 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6461 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6462 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6463 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006464 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6465 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006466 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6467
6468 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6469 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6470 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6471 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6472 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6473 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6474 are often the only way to detect them.
6475
6476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6478
6479 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6480
6481
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006482option http-keep-alive
6483no option http-keep-alive
6484 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | yes | yes | yes
6487 Arguments : none
6488
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006489 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6490 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006491 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6492 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6493 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6494 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6495 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006496
6497 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6498 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006499 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6500 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6501 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6502 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6503 situations where this option may be useful :
6504
6505 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006506 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006507
6508 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6509 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6510
6511 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6512 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6513 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6514 request.
6515
6516 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6517 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006518 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6519 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6520 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006521
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006522 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6523 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6524 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6525 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6526 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6527 not set.
6528
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006529 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006530 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6531 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006532
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006533 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006534 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006535 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006536
6537
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006538option http-no-delay
6539no option http-no-delay
6540 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6542 yes | yes | yes | yes
6543 Arguments : none
6544
6545 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6546 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6547 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6548 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6549 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6550 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6551 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6552 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6553 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6554 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6555 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6556 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6557 affected.
6558
6559 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6560 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6561 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6562 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6563 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6564 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6565 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6566 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6567 latency environments.
6568
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006569 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6570
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006571
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006572option http-pretend-keepalive
6573no option http-pretend-keepalive
6574 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006576 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006577 Arguments : none
6578
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006580 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6581 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6582 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6583 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6584 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6585 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6586 consider the response complete.
6587
6588 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6589 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6590 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6591 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006592 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006593 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6594
6595 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6596 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6597 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6598 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6599 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6600 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6601 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6602
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006603 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6604 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6605 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6606 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6607 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6608 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006609
6610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6612
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006613 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006614 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006615
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006616
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006617option http-server-close
6618no option http-server-close
6619 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6621 yes | yes | yes | yes
6622 Arguments : none
6623
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006624 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6625 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6626 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6627 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006628 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6629 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6630 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6631 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6632 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6633 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6634 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6635 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6636 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6637 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6638 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006639
6640 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6641 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6642 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6643 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006644 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6645 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006646
6647 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6648 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006649 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6650 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6651 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006652
6653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6655
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006656 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6657 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006658
6659
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006660option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6661no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6662 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006664 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006665 Arguments : none
6666
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006667 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6668 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6669 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6670
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006671 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6672 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6673 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6674 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006675 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006676
6677 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006678 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006679 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6680 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6681 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6682 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6683 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6684 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6685 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006686
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006687 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6688 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6689 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6690 backend.
6691
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6694
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006695 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6696 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006697
6698
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006699option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006700no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006701 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6703 yes | yes | yes | no
6704 Arguments : none
6705
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006706 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006707 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6708 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6709 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6710 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6711 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6712 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6713
6714 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6715 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006716 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6717 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6718 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006719
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006720 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6721 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6722 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6723 front of an existing proxy.
6724
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006725 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6726
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006727 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006728
6729
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006730option http-use-htx
6731no option http-use-htx
6732 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6734 yes | yes | yes | yes
6735 Arguments : none
6736
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006737 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006738 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006739 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6740 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6741 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6742 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6743 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006744
6745 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6746 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6747 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6748 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006749 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6750 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6751 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6752 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006753
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006754 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6755 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6756 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6757 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6758 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006759
6760 See also : "mode http"
6761
6762
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006763option httpchk
6764option httpchk <uri>
6765option httpchk <method> <uri>
6766option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6767 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6769 yes | no | yes | yes
6770 Arguments :
6771 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6772 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6773 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6774 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6775 ones.
6776
6777 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6778 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6779 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6780
6781 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6782 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6783 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006784 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006785
6786 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6787 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6788 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6789 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6790 the lack of any response.
6791
6792 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6793
6794 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6795 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6796 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6797
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006798 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6799 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6800 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6801 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6802
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006803 Examples :
6804 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6805 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6806 backend https_relay
6807 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006808 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6809 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006810 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6811
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006812 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6813 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6814 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006815
6816
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006817option httpclose
6818no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006819 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6821 yes | yes | yes | yes
6822 Arguments : none
6823
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006824 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6825 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6826 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6827 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006828 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006829
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006830 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6831 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006832 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006833 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6834 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006835
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006836 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6837 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6838 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006839
6840 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6841 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006842 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006843 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6844 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6845 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006846
6847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6849
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006850 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006851
6852
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006853option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006854 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006856 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006857 Arguments :
6858 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6859 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6860 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006861 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006862 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006863
6864 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6865 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6866 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6867 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6868 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6869 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6870 ports.
6871
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006872 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6873 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006874
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006875 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006877 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006878
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006879
6880option http_proxy
6881no option http_proxy
6882 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6884 yes | yes | yes | yes
6885 Arguments : none
6886
6887 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6888 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6889 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6890 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6891 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6892
6893 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6894 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006895 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6896 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006897
6898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6900
6901 Example :
6902 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6903 backend direct_forward
6904 option httpclose
6905 option http_proxy
6906
6907 See also : "option httpclose"
6908
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006909
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006910option independent-streams
6911no option independent-streams
6912 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 yes | yes | yes | yes
6915 Arguments : none
6916
6917 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6918 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6919 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6920 receive data or not.
6921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006922 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006923 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6924 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6925 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6926 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6927 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6928 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6929 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6930 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6931 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6932 socket buffers.
6933
6934 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6935 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6936 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6937 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6938 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6939
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006940 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006941 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6942 deprecated.
6943
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006944 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006945
6946
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006947option ldap-check
6948 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951 Arguments : none
6952
6953 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6954 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6955 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6956 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6957
6958 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6959 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6960
6961 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6962 configure it.
6963
6964 Example :
6965 option ldap-check
6966
6967 See also : "option httpchk"
6968
6969
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006970option external-check
6971 Use external processes for server health checks
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 yes | no | yes | yes
6974
6975 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6976 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6977 command".
6978
6979 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6980
6981 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6982
6983
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006984option log-health-checks
6985no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006986 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 yes | no | yes | yes
6989 Arguments : none
6990
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006991 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6992 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6993 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006994
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006995 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6996 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6997 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6998 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6999 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007001 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007002 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007003
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007004 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7005 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7006 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007007
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007008
7009option log-separate-errors
7010no option log-separate-errors
7011 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7013 yes | yes | yes | no
7014 Arguments : none
7015
7016 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7017 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7018 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7019 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7020 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7021 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7022 provides very important information.
7023
7024 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7025 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7026 error logs.
7027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007028 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007029 logging.
7030
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007031
7032option logasap
7033no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007034 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | yes | yes | no
7037 Arguments : none
7038
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007039 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7040 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7041 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7042 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7043
7044 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7045 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7046 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7047 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7048 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7049 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7050 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7051 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7052 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7053 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7054 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007055
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007056 Examples :
7057 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7058 mode http
7059 option httplog
7060 option logasap
7061 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7062
7063 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7064 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7065 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7066 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007068 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007069 logging.
7070
7071
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007072option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007073 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007076 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007077 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7078 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007079 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007080
7081 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7082 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007084 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7085 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7086 in the MySQL table, like this :
7087
7088 USE mysql;
7089 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7090 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7091
7092 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007093 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007094 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7095 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7096 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7097 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7098 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7099 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7100 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7101
7102 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7103 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007104
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007105 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007106
7107 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7108 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7109 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7110 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007111 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7112 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007113
7114 See also: "option httpchk"
7115
7116
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007117option nolinger
7118no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007119 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007122 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007123
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007124 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007125 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7126 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7127 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7128 connections.
7129
7130 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7131 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7132 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7133 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7134 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7135 this too.
7136
7137 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7138 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7139 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7140
7141 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7142 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7143 for servers.
7144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
7148
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007149option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7150 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7152 yes | yes | yes | yes
7153 Arguments :
7154 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7155 matching <network>
7156 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7157 header name.
7158
7159 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7160 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7161 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7162 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7163 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7164 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7165 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7166 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7167 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7168 possible that the client has already brought one.
7169
7170 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7171 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7172 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7173 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7174 header and requires different one.
7175
7176 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7177 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7178 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7179 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7180 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7181 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7182 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7183
Christopher Faulet313fa092021-04-06 09:01:09 +02007184 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
7185 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
7186
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007187 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7188 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7189 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7190 both are defined.
7191
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007192 Examples :
7193 # Original Destination address
7194 frontend www
7195 mode http
7196 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7197
7198 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7199 backend www
7200 mode http
7201 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007203 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007204
7205
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007206option persist
7207no option persist
7208 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007211 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007212
7213 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7214 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7215 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7216 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7217 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7218 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7219 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7220 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7221 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7222 redirected to another valid server.
7223
7224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7226
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007227 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007228
7229
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007230option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7231 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | no | yes | yes
7234 Arguments :
7235 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7236 PostgreSQL server.
7237
7238 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7239 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7240 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7241 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7242
7243 See also: "option httpchk"
7244
7245
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007246option prefer-last-server
7247no option prefer-last-server
7248 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7250 yes | no | yes | yes
7251 Arguments : none
7252
7253 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7254 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7255 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7256 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7257 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7258 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7259 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7260 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7261 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007262 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7263 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007264 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7265 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7266 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007267 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7268 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7269 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007270
7271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7273
7274 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7275
7276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007277option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007278option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007279no option redispatch
7280 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7282 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007283 Arguments :
7284 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7285 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7286 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007287 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007288 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007289 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007290 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7291 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7292 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007294
7295 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7296 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7297 be able to access the service anymore.
7298
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007299 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7300 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007301
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007302 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007303 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7304 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007306 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7307 "redisp" keywords.
7308
7309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7311
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007312 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007313
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007314
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007315option redis-check
7316 Use redis health checks for server testing
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | no | yes | yes
7319 Arguments : none
7320
7321 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7322 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7323 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7324 find the "+PONG" response message.
7325
7326 Example :
7327 option redis-check
7328
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007329 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007330
7331
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007332option smtpchk
7333option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7334 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007337 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007338 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007339 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007340 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7341
7342 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7343 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7344 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7345
7346 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7347 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7348 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7349 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7350 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7351 dead server.
7352
7353 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7354 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007355 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007356 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7357
7358 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7359 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7360 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7361 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007362 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007363
7364 Example :
7365 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7366
7367 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007370option socket-stats
7371no option socket-stats
7372
7373 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | yes | yes | no
7376
7377 Arguments : none
7378
7379
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007380option splice-auto
7381no option splice-auto
7382 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7384 yes | yes | yes | yes
7385 Arguments : none
7386
7387 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7388 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007389 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007390 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007391 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007392 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7393 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7394 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7395 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7396
7397 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7398 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7399 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7400 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7401 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7402 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7403 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7404 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7405 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7406 keyword.
7407
7408 Example :
7409 option splice-auto
7410
7411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7413
7414 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7415 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7416
7417
7418option splice-request
7419no option splice-request
7420 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7422 yes | yes | yes | yes
7423 Arguments : none
7424
7425 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007426 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007427 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7428 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7429 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7430 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7431
7432 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7433
7434 Example :
7435 option splice-request
7436
7437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7439
7440 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7441 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7442
7443
7444option splice-response
7445no option splice-response
7446 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7448 yes | yes | yes | yes
7449 Arguments : none
7450
7451 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007452 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007453 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7454 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7455 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7456 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7457
7458 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7459
7460 Example :
7461 option splice-response
7462
7463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7465
7466 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7467 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7468
7469
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007470option spop-check
7471 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 no | no | no | yes
7474 Arguments : none
7475
7476 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7477 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7478 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7479 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7480
7481 Example :
7482 option spop-check
7483
7484 See also : "option httpchk"
7485
7486
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007487option srvtcpka
7488no option srvtcpka
7489 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7491 yes | no | yes | yes
7492 Arguments : none
7493
7494 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7495 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007496 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007497 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7498
7499 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7500 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7501 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7502 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7503
7504 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7505 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7506 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7507 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7508 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7509
7510 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7511
7512 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7513 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7514 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7515
7516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7518
7519 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7520
7521
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007522option ssl-hello-chk
7523 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 yes | no | yes | yes
7526 Arguments : none
7527
7528 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7529 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7530 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7531 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7532 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7533 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7534 hello message.
7535
7536 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7537 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7538 messages, which is appreciable.
7539
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007540 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7541 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7542 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007543
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007544 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7545
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007546
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007547option tcp-check
7548 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7550 yes | no | yes | yes
7551
7552 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7553 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7554
7555 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7556 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7557 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007559 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007560 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7561 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7562 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7563 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7564 only.
7565
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007566 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007567 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7568 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7569 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7570 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007572 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007573 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7574 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007575 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007576 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7577 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7578 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7579 the respective protocols.
7580 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007581 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007582
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007583 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7584 script.
7585
7586 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7587 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7588 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7589 The "comment" is of course optional.
7590
7591
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007592 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007594 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007595 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007596
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007597 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007598 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007599 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007600
7601 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7602 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007603 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007604 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007605 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007606 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007607 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007608 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007609 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7610 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007611 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007612 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7613 tcp-check expect string +OK
7614
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007615 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007616 (send many headers before analyzing)
7617 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007618 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007619 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7620 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7621 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7622 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007623 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007624
7625
7626 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7627
7628
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007629option tcp-smart-accept
7630no option tcp-smart-accept
7631 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 yes | yes | yes | no
7634 Arguments : none
7635
7636 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7637 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7638 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7639 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7640 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7641 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7642
7643 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7644 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7645 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7646 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7647
7648 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7649 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7650 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007651 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007652
7653 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7654 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7655 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7656
7657 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7658 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7659 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7660
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007661 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7662
7663
7664option tcp-smart-connect
7665no option tcp-smart-connect
7666 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7668 yes | no | yes | yes
7669 Arguments : none
7670
7671 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7672 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7673 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7674 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7675 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7676
7677 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7678 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7679 complex.
7680
7681 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7682 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7683 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7684
7685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7687
7688 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7689
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007690
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007691option tcpka
7692 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 yes | yes | yes | yes
7695 Arguments : none
7696
7697 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7698 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007699 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007700 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7701
7702 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7703 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7704 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7705 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7706
7707 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7708 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7709 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7710 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7711 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7712
7713 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7714
7715 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7716 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7717 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7718 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7719 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7720 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7721 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7722 backends.
7723
7724 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7725
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007726
7727option tcplog
7728 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007730 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007731 Arguments : none
7732
7733 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7734 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7735 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7736 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7737 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7738 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7739 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7740 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7741
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007742 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007744 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007745
7746
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007747option transparent
7748no option transparent
7749 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007751 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007752 Arguments : none
7753
7754 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7755 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7756 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7757 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7758 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7759 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7760 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7761 appropriate server.
7762
7763 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7764 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7765
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007766 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007767 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007768
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007769
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007770external-check command <command>
7771 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 yes | no | yes | yes
7774
7775 Arguments :
7776 <command> is the external command to run
7777
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007778 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7779
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007780 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007781
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007782 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7783 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7784 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7785 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7786 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7787 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007788
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007789 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7790
7791 Environment variables :
7792 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7793 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7794
7795 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7796
7797 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7798
7799 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7800 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7801 for a UNIX socket).
7802
7803 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7804
7805 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7806
7807 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7808
7809 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7810
7811 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7812
7813 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7814 socket).
7815
7816 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7817 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7818
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007819 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7820
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007821 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7822 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7823 failed.
7824
7825 Example :
7826 external-check command /bin/true
7827
7828 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7829
7830
7831external-check path <path>
7832 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7834 yes | no | yes | yes
7835
7836 Arguments :
7837 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7838
7839 The default path is "".
7840
7841 Example :
7842 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7843
7844 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7845 "external-check command"
7846
7847
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007848persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007849persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007850 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 yes | no | yes | yes
7853 Arguments :
7854 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007855 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7856 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007857
7858 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7859 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007860 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007861 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7862 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7863 forwarded to this server.
7864
7865 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7866 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7867 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007868 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007869 a single "listen" section.
7870
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007871 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7872 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7873 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7874
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007875 Example :
7876 listen tse-farm
7877 bind :3389
7878 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7879 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7880 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7881 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7882 persist rdp-cookie
7883 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007884 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007885 balance rdp-cookie
7886 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7887 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7888
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007889 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7890 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007891
7892
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007893rate-limit sessions <rate>
7894 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | yes | yes | no
7897 Arguments :
7898 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7899 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7900
7901 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7902 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7903 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7904 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7905 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7906 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7907
7908 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7909 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7910 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7911 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7912
7913 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7914 listen smtp
7915 mode tcp
7916 bind :25
7917 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007918 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007919
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007920 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7921 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7922 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007923
7924 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7925
7926
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007927redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7928redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7929redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007930 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 no | yes | yes | yes
7933
7934 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007935 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007936
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007937 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007938 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007939 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7940 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7941 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007942
7943 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7944 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7945 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7946 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7947 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007948 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7949 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7950 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7951 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007952
7953 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7954 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7955 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7956 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7957 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7958 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007959 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007960 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007961 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7962 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7963 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007964
7965 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007966 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7967 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7968 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007969 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007970 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7971 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7972 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7973 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007974
7975 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007976 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007977
7978 - "drop-query"
7979 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7980 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7981 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7982 with a location-type redirect.
7983
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007984 - "append-slash"
7985 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7986 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7987 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7988 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7989
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007990 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7991 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7992 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7993 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7994 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7995 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7996 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7997
7998 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7999 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8000 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8001 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8002 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8003 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8004 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008005
8006 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8007 acl clear dst_port 80
8008 acl secure dst_port 8080
8009 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008010 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008011 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008012 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8013
8014 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008015 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8016 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8017 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008018 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008019
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008020 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8021 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8022 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8023
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008024 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008025 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008026
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008027 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008028 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8029 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8030 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008032 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008033
8034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008035redisp (deprecated)
8036redispatch (deprecated)
8037 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008040 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008041
8042 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8043 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8044 be able to access the service anymore.
8045
8046 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8047 redistribute them to a working server.
8048
8049 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8050 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8051 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008053 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8054 "option redispatch" instead.
8055
8056 See also : "option redispatch"
8057
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008058
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008059reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008060 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8062 no | yes | yes | yes
8063 Arguments :
8064 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8065 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008066 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008067
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008068 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8069 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8070
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008071 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8072 the last header of an HTTP request.
8073
8074 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8075 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8076 responses.
8077
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008078 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8079 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8080 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8081
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008082 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8083 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008084
8085
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008086reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8087reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008088 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 no | yes | yes | yes
8091 Arguments :
8092 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8093 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8094 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8095 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8096 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8097 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8098 ignores case.
8099
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008100 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8101 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8102
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008103 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8104 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8105 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8106 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008107 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008108
8109 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8110 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8111
8112 Example :
8113 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8114 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8115 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8116
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008117 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8118 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008119
8120
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008121reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8122reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008123 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 no | yes | yes | yes
8126 Arguments :
8127 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8128 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8129 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8130 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8131 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8132 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8133
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008134 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8135 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8136
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008137 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8138 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8139 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8140 next servers.
8141
8142 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8143 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8144 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8145
8146 Example :
8147 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8148 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8149 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8150
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008151 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8152 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008153
8154
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008155reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8156reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008157 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8159 no | yes | yes | yes
8160 Arguments :
8161 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8162 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8163 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8164 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8165 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8166 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8167 case.
8168
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008169 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8170 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8171
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008172 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8173 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8174 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8175 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008176 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008177
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008178 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008179 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008180 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008181
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008182 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8183 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8184
8185 Example :
8186 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8187 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8188 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8189
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008190 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8191 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008192
8193
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008194reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8195reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008196 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8198 no | yes | yes | yes
8199 Arguments :
8200 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8201 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8202 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8203 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8204 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8205 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8206 case.
8207
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008208 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8209 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8210
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008211 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8212 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8213 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8214 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8215
8216 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8217 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8218
8219 Example :
8220 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8221 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8222 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8223 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8224
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008225 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8226 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008227
8228
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008229reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8230reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008231 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8233 no | yes | yes | yes
8234 Arguments :
8235 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8236 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8237 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8238 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8239 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8240 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8241
8242 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8243 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8244 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8245 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008246 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008247
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008248 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8249 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8250
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008251 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8252 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8253 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8254
8255 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8256 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8257 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8258 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8259 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8260
8261 Example :
8262 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008263 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008264 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8265 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8266
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008267 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8268 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008269
8270
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008271reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8272reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008273 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8275 no | yes | yes | yes
8276 Arguments :
8277 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8278 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8279 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8280 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8281 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8282 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8283 ignores case.
8284
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008285 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8286 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8287
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008288 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8289 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008290 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8291 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8292 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008293 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8294 not set.
8295
8296 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8297 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8298 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8299 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8300 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8301
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008302 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008303 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008304 # block all others.
8305 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8306 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8307
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008308 # block bad guys
8309 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8310 reqitarpit . if badguys
8311
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008312 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8313 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008314
8315
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008316retries <value>
8317 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8319 yes | no | yes | yes
8320 Arguments :
8321 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8322 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8323 default value is 3.
8324
8325 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8326 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8327 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8328
8329 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008330 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8331 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008332
8333 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8334 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8335
8336 See also : "option redispatch"
8337
8338
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008339retry-on [list of keywords]
8340 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | no | yes | yes
8343 Arguments :
8344 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8345 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8346 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8347 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8348
8349 none never retry
8350
8351 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8352 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8353
8354 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8355 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8356 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8357 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8358 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8359 processing the request.
8360
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008361 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8362 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8363 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8364 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8365 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8366 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8367 overflow attack for example).
8368
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008369 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8370 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8371 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8372 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8373 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8374 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8375 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8376 amplify denial of service attacks.
8377
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008378 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8379 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8380 considered to be safe to retry.
8381
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008382 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8383 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8384 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8385 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8386
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008387 all-retryable-errors
8388 retry request for any error that are considered
8389 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8390 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8391 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8392
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008393 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8394 not cumulative.
8395
8396 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8397 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8398 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8399 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8400
8401 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8402 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8403 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8404 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8405 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8406 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8407 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8408 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8409 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8410 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8411 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8412 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8413
8414 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8415 should not use this directive.
8416
8417 The default is "conn-failure".
8418
8419 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8420
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008421rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008422 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 no | yes | yes | yes
8425 Arguments :
8426 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8427 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008428 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008429
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008430 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8431 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8432
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008433 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8434 the last header of an HTTP response.
8435
8436 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8437 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8438 responses.
8439
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008440 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8441 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008442
8443
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008444rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8445rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008446 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8448 no | yes | yes | yes
8449 Arguments :
8450 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8451 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8452 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8453 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8454 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8455 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8456 ignores case.
8457
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008458 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8459 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8460
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008461 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8462 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008463 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008464 client.
8465
8466 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8467 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8468 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8469
8470 Example :
8471 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008472 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008473
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008474 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8475 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008476
8477
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008478rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8479rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008480 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8482 no | yes | yes | yes
8483 Arguments :
8484 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8485 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8486 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8487 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8488 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8489 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8490 ignores case.
8491
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008492 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8493 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8494
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008495 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8496 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8497 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8498 case-sensitive.
8499
8500 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008501 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8502 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8503 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008504
8505 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8506 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8507
8508 Example :
8509 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8510 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8511
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008512 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8513 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008514
8515
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008516rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8517rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008518 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8520 no | yes | yes | yes
8521 Arguments :
8522 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8523 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8524 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8525 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8526 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8527 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8528 ignores case.
8529
8530 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8531 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8532 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8533 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008534 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008535
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008536 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8537 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8538
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008539 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8540 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8541 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8542
8543 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8544 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8545 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8546 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8547 are not case-sensitive.
8548
8549 Example :
8550 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8551 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8552
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008553 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8554 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008555
8556
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008557server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008558 Declare a server in a backend
8559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 no | no | yes | yes
8561 Arguments :
8562 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008563 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008564 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008565
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008566 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8567 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8568 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8569 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008570 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8571 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8572 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8573 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8574 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008575 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8576 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8577 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8578 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8579 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8580 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8581 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008582 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008583 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8584 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8585 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8586 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8587 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8588 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008589 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8590 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008591 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8592 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008593
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008594 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008595 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8596 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8597 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8598 adding this value to the client's port.
8599
8600 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8601 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008602 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008603
8604 Examples :
8605 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8606 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008607 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008608 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8609 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8610 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008611
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008612 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8613 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8614 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8615 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8616 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8617
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008618 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8619 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008620
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008621server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008622 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008623 this backend.
8624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 no | no | yes | yes
8626
8627 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
8628 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
8629 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
8630 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
8631 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008632
8633 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8634 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8635
8636 global
8637 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8638
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008639 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008640 load-server-state-from-file
8641
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008642 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008643 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008644
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008645server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8646 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8647 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8649 no | no | yes | yes
8650
8651 Arguments:
8652 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8653
8654 <num | range>
8655 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8656 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8657 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8658 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8659
8660 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8661
8662 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8663
8664 <params*>
8665 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8666 keyword.
8667
8668 Examples:
8669 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8670 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8671 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8672
8673 # or
8674 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8675
8676 # would be equivalent to:
8677 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8678 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8679 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8680
8681
8682
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008683source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008684source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008685source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008686 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8688 yes | no | yes | yes
8689 Arguments :
8690 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8691 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008692
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008693 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008694 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8695 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8696 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8697 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8698 supported prefixes are :
8699 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8700 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8701 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008702 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008703 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8704 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008705
8706 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8707 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008708 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8709 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8710 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008711
8712 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8713 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8714 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8715 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8716 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8717 <addr>.
8718
8719 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8720 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8721 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8722 port.
8723
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008724 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8725 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8726 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8727 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008728 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008729 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8730 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8731 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8732 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8733 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8734 HTTP header.
8735
8736 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8737 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008738 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008739 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8740 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8741 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8742 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8743 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8744 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8745 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8746
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008747 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8748 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8749 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8750 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8751 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8752 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8753
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008754 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8755 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8756 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8757 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8758
8759 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8760 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8761 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8762 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8763 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8764 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8765
8766 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8767 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8768 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8769 there are two methods :
8770
8771 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8772 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8773 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8774 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8775 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8776 of the client ranges may be used.
8777
8778 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8779 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8780 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8781 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8782 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8783 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8784 same session.
8785
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008786 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8787 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8788 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008789 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008790
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008791 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8792
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008793 Examples :
8794 backend private
8795 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8796 source 192.168.1.200
8797
8798 backend transparent_ssl1
8799 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8800 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8801
8802 backend transparent_ssl2
8803 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8804 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8805 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8806
8807 backend transparent_ssl3
8808 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8809 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8810 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8811
8812 backend transparent_smtp
8813 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8814 # with Tproxy version 4.
8815 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8816
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008817 backend transparent_http
8818 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8819 # proxy.
8820 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008822 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008823 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008825
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008826srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8827 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8829 yes | no | yes | yes
8830 Arguments :
8831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8833 as explained at the top of this document.
8834
8835 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8836 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8837 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8838 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8839 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8840 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8841 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8842
8843 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8844 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8845 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8846 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8847 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008848 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008849 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008850 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008851
8852 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8853 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8854 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8855 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8856 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8857 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8858
8859 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8860 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8861
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008862 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8863 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008864
8865
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008866stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8867 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008869 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008870
8871 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8872 matched.
8873
8874 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8875 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8876
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008877 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8878 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008879 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008880
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008881 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8882 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8883 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8884 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008885
8886 Example :
8887 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8888 backend stats_localhost
8889 stats enable
8890 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8891
8892 Example :
8893 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8894 backend stats_auth
8895 stats enable
8896 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8897 stats admin if TRUE
8898
8899 Example :
8900 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8901 userlist stats-auth
8902 group admin users admin
8903 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8904 group readonly users haproxy
8905 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8906
8907 backend stats_auth
8908 stats enable
8909 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8910 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8911 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8912 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8913
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008914 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8915 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8916 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008917
8918
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008919stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8920 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008922 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008923 Arguments :
8924 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8925
8926 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8927
8928 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8929 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8930 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8931 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8932 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8933 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8934
8935 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8936 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8937 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008938 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008939
8940 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8941 report using "stats scope".
8942
8943 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8944 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8945 unobvious parameters.
8946
8947 Example :
8948 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8949 backend public_www
8950 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8951 stats enable
8952 stats hide-version
8953 stats scope .
8954 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008955 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008956 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8957 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8958
8959 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8960 backend private_monitoring
8961 stats enable
8962 stats uri /admin?stats
8963 stats refresh 5s
8964
8965 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8966
8967
8968stats enable
8969 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008971 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008972 Arguments : none
8973
8974 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8975 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8976 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8977 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8978 - stats auth : no authentication
8979 - stats scope : no restriction
8980
8981 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8982 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8983 unobvious parameters.
8984
8985 Example :
8986 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8987 backend public_www
8988 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8989 stats enable
8990 stats hide-version
8991 stats scope .
8992 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008993 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008994 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8995 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8996
8997 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8998 backend private_monitoring
8999 stats enable
9000 stats uri /admin?stats
9001 stats refresh 5s
9002
9003 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9004
9005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009006stats hide-version
9007 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009009 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009010 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009011
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009012 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9013 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9014 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9015 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9016 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9017 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009019 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9020 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9021 unobvious parameters.
9022
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009023 Example :
9024 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9025 backend public_www
9026 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009027 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009028 stats hide-version
9029 stats scope .
9030 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009031 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9033 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009034
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009035 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9036 backend private_monitoring
9037 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009038 stats uri /admin?stats
9039 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009040
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009041 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009042
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009043
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009044stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9045 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9046 Access control for statistics
9047
9048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9049 no | no | yes | yes
9050
9051 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9052 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9053 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9054 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9055 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9056 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9057
9058 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9059 instance.
9060
9061 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9062 about ACL usage.
9063
9064
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009065stats realm <realm>
9066 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009068 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009069 Arguments :
9070 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9071 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9072 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9073
9074 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9075 using a backslash ('\').
9076
9077 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9078 only related to authentication.
9079
9080 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9081 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9082 unobvious parameters.
9083
9084 Example :
9085 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9086 backend public_www
9087 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9088 stats enable
9089 stats hide-version
9090 stats scope .
9091 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009092 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009093 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9094 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9095
9096 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9097 backend private_monitoring
9098 stats enable
9099 stats uri /admin?stats
9100 stats refresh 5s
9101
9102 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9103
9104
9105stats refresh <delay>
9106 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009108 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009109 Arguments :
9110 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9111 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9112 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9113 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9114 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9115 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9116
9117 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9118 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9119 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9120 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9121
9122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9124 unobvious parameters.
9125
9126 Example :
9127 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9128 backend public_www
9129 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9130 stats enable
9131 stats hide-version
9132 stats scope .
9133 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009134 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009135 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9136 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9137
9138 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9139 backend private_monitoring
9140 stats enable
9141 stats uri /admin?stats
9142 stats refresh 5s
9143
9144 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9145
9146
9147stats scope { <name> | "." }
9148 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009151 Arguments :
9152 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9153 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9154 section in which the statement appears.
9155
9156 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9157 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9158 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9159 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9160 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9161 exists.
9162
9163 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9164 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9165 unobvious parameters.
9166
9167 Example :
9168 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9169 backend public_www
9170 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9171 stats enable
9172 stats hide-version
9173 stats scope .
9174 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009175 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009176 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9177 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9178
9179 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9180 backend private_monitoring
9181 stats enable
9182 stats uri /admin?stats
9183 stats refresh 5s
9184
9185 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9186
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009187
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009188stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009189 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009191 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009192
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009193 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009194 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9195
9196 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9197 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9198
9199 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9200 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009201 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009202
9203 Example :
9204 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9205 backend private_monitoring
9206 stats enable
9207 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9208 stats uri /admin?stats
9209 stats refresh 5s
9210
9211 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9212 global section.
9213
9214
9215stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009216 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 yes | yes | yes | yes
9219 Arguments : none
9220
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009221 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009222 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9223 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9224 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9225 - IP (socket, server)
9226 - cookie (backend, server)
9227
9228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009230 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009231
9232 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9233
9234
9235stats show-node [ <name> ]
9236 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009238 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009239 Arguments:
9240 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9241 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9242
9243 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9244 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009245 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009246
9247 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9248 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9249 unobvious parameters.
9250
9251 Example:
9252 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9253 backend private_monitoring
9254 stats enable
9255 stats show-node Europe-1
9256 stats uri /admin?stats
9257 stats refresh 5s
9258
9259 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9260 section.
9261
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009262
9263stats uri <prefix>
9264 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009266 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009267 Arguments :
9268 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9269 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9270 query string.
9271
9272 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9273 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9274 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9275 possible to reach it in the application.
9276
9277 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009278 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009279 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9280 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9281 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9282 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9283
9284 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9285 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9286 an address or a port to statistics only.
9287
9288 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9289 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9290 unobvious parameters.
9291
9292 Example :
9293 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9294 backend public_www
9295 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9296 stats enable
9297 stats hide-version
9298 stats scope .
9299 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009300 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009301 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9302 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9303
9304 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9305 backend private_monitoring
9306 stats enable
9307 stats uri /admin?stats
9308 stats refresh 5s
9309
9310 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9311
9312
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009313stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9314 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009316 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009317
9318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009319 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009320 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009321 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009322 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9323
9324 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9325 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9326 the "stick-table" statement.
9327
9328 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9329 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9330 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9331 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9332 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9333
9334 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9335 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9336 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9337 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9338 transformation rules.
9339
9340 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9341 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9342 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9343 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9344 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9345 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9346 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9347
9348 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9349 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9350 ACL based conditions.
9351
9352 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9353 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9354 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9355 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9356
9357 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9358 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9359 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9360 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9361
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009362 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9363 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009365
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009366 Example :
9367 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9368 # last 30 minutes
9369 backend pop
9370 mode tcp
9371 balance roundrobin
9372 stick store-request src
9373 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9374 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9375 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9376
9377 backend smtp
9378 mode tcp
9379 balance roundrobin
9380 stick match src table pop
9381 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9382 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9383
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009384 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009385 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009386
9387
9388stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9389 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9391 no | no | yes | yes
9392
9393 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9394 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9395 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9396 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9397
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009398 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9399 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009400 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009401
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009402 Examples :
9403 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009404 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009405
9406 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9407 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9408 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9409
9410
9411 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9412 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9413 backend http
9414 mode http
9415 balance roundrobin
9416 stick on src table https
9417 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9418 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9419 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9420
9421 backend https
9422 mode tcp
9423 balance roundrobin
9424 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9425 stick on src
9426 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9427 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9428
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009429 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009430
9431
9432stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9433 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9435 no | no | yes | yes
9436
9437 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009438 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009439 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009440 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009441 server is selected.
9442
9443 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9444 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9445 the "stick-table" statement.
9446
9447 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9448 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9449 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9450 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9451 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9452 address.
9453
9454 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9455 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9456 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9457 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9458 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9459 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9460 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9461 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9462 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9463 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9464
9465 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9466 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9467 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9468 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9469 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9470 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9471 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9472
9473 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9474 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9475 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9476 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9477
9478 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9479 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9480 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9481 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9482 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9483 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009484 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9485 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9486 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9487 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9488 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9489 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009490
9491 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9492 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9493 the request.
9494
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009495 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9496 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009497 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009498
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009499 Example :
9500 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9501 # last 30 minutes
9502 backend pop
9503 mode tcp
9504 balance roundrobin
9505 stick store-request src
9506 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9507 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9508 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9509
9510 backend smtp
9511 mode tcp
9512 balance roundrobin
9513 stick match src table pop
9514 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9515 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9516
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009517 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009518 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009519
9520
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009521stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009522 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9523 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009524 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009526 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009527
9528 Arguments :
9529 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9530 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9531 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9532 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9533
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009534 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9535 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9536 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9537 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9538
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009539 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9540 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9541 instance.
9542
9543 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9544 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9545 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9546 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9547 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9548 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009549 to 32 characters.
9550
9551 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9552 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9553 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009554 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009555 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9556 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009557
9558 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009559 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9560 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009561 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9562 increase.
9563
9564 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009565 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9566 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9567 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009568
9569 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9570 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9571 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9572 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009573 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009574 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9575 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9576 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9577 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9578 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9579 parameter (see below).
9580
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009581 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9582 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9583 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9584 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9585 soft restart.
9586
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009587 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9588 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009589
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009590 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9591 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9592 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9593 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009594 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009595 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009596 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9597 if not expiration delay is specified.
9598
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009599 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9600 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9601 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9602 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009603 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9604 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9605 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9606 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9607 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9608 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9609 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9610 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9611 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9612 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9613 types and their arguments.
9614
9615 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9616 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9617 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9618 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9619
9620 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9621 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9622 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009624
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009625 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9626 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9627 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009628 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009629 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009630 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009632 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9633 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9634 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9635 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9636
9637 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9638 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9639 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9640 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9641 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9642 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9643
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009644 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9645 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9646 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9647 they were received.
9648
9649 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9650 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9651 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9652 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9653 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9654
9655 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9656 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9657 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9658 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9659 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9660
9661 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9662 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9663 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9664
9665 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9666 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9667 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9668 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9669 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9670
9671 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9672 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9673 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9674 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9675 the client side.
9676
9677 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9678 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9679 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9680 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9681 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9682 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9683 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9684
9685 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9686 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9687 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9688 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9689 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9690 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009691 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009692
9693 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9694 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9695 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9696 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9697 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9698 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9699
9700 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009701 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009702 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9703 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9704
9705 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9706 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9707 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9708 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9709 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9710 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9711 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9712 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9713 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9714 recommended for better fairness.
9715
9716 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009717 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009718 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9719 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9720
9721 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9722 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9723 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9724 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9725 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9726 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9727 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9728 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9729 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9730 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009731
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009732 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9733 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009734 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9735 reference it.
9736
9737 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9738 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009739 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9740 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9741 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009742
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009743 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9744 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9745 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9746 something that can be ignored.
9747
9748 Example:
9749 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9750 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9751 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9752 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9753
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009754 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009755 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009756
9757
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009758stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009759 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9761 no | no | yes | yes
9762
9763 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009764 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009765 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009767 server is selected.
9768
9769 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9770 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9771 the "stick-table" statement.
9772
9773 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9774 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9775 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9776 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9777
9778 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9779 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9780 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9781 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9782 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9783 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009784 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009785 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9786 rules.
9787
9788 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9789 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9790 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9791 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9792 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9793 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9794 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9795
9796 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9797 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9798 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9799 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9800
9801 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9802 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9803 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9804 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9805 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9806 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009807 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9808 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9809 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9810 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9811 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9812 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9813 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9814 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9815 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009816
9817 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9818
9819 Example :
9820 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9821 backend https
9822 mode tcp
9823 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009824 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009825 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009826
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009827 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9828 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9829
9830 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9831 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9832 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9833
9834 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9835 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009836
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009837 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9838 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9839 # at offset 44.
9840
9841 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9842 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9843
9844 # Learn on response if server hello.
9845 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009846
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009847 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9848 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9849
9850 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9851 extraction.
9852
9853
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009854tcp-check connect [params*]
9855 Opens a new connection
9856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9857 no | no | yes | yes
9858
9859 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9860 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9861 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9862
9863 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9864 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9865 of the sequence.
9866
9867 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9868 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9869 do.
9870
9871 Parameters :
9872 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9873 use the TCP connection.
9874
9875 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9876 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9877 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9878
9879 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9880
9881 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9882
9883 Examples:
9884 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9885 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9886 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9887 option tcp-check
9888 tcp-check connect
9889 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9890 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9891 tcp-check send \r\n
9892 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9893 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9894 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9895 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9896 tcp-check send \r\n
9897 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9898 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9899
9900 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9901 option tcp-check
9902 tcp-check connect port 110
9903 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9904 tcp-check connect port 143
9905 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9906 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9907
9908 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9909
9910
9911tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009912 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9914 no | no | yes | yes
9915
9916 Arguments :
9917 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9918 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9919 binary.
9920 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9921 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9922 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9923
9924 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9925 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9926 with the usual backslash ('\').
9927 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009928 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009929 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9930 used upper or lower case.
9931
9932
9933 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9934
9935 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9936 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9937 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9938 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9939 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9940 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9941 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9942 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9943
9944 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9945 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9946 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9947 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9948 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9949 expression.
9950
9951 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9952 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9953 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9954 this exact hexadecimal string.
9955 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9956
9957 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9958 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9959 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9960 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9961 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9962 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9963 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9964 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9965 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9966 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9967 the null character.
9968
9969 Examples :
9970 # perform a POP check
9971 option tcp-check
9972 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9973
9974 # perform an IMAP check
9975 option tcp-check
9976 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9977
9978 # look for the redis master server
9979 option tcp-check
9980 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009981 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009982 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9983 tcp-check expect string role:master
9984 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9985 tcp-check expect string +OK
9986
9987
9988 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9989 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9990
9991
9992tcp-check send <data>
9993 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 no | no | yes | yes
9996
9997 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9998 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9999
10000 Examples :
10001 # look for the redis master server
10002 option tcp-check
10003 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10004 tcp-check expect string role:master
10005
10006 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10007 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10008
10009
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010010tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10011 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010012 tcp health check
10013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10014 no | no | yes | yes
10015
10016 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10017 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010018 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010019 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10020 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10021 hexadecimal string.
10022 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10023
10024 Examples :
10025 # redis check in binary
10026 option tcp-check
10027 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10028 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10029
10030
10031 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10032 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10033
10034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010035tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10036 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10038 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010040 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10041 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010043 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010044
10045 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10046 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010047 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10048 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10049 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10050 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10051 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10052 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010054 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10055 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10056 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10057 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010058
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010059 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010060 - accept :
10061 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10062 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10063 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010065 - reject :
10066 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10067 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10068 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10069 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10070 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10071 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10072 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10073 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10074 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10075 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10076 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010077 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010078
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010079 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10080 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10081 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10082 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10083 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10084 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10085 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10086 hosts.
10087
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010088 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10089 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10090 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10091 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10092 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10093 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10094 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10095 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10096
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010097 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10098 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10099 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10100 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10101 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10102 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10103 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10104 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10105 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010106 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10107 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010108
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010109 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010110 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010111 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10112 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10113 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010114 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010115 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10116 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10117 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10118 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10119 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10120 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10121 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10122 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010124 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010125 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010127 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010128 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10129 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10130 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010132 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10133 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10134 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10135 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010137 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10138 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10139 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10140 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10141 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010142 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10143 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10144 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10145 layer7 information is extracted.
10146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010147 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10148 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10149 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10150 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10151 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010152
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010153 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10154 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10155 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10156 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10157
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010158 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10159 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10160 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10161 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10162
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010163 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10164 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10165 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10166 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10167 continues.
10168
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010169 - set-src <expr> :
10170 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10171 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10172 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010173 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010175 Arguments:
10176 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10177 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010178
10179 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010180 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10181
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010182 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10183 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010184
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010185 - set-src-port <expr> :
10186 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10187 expression.
10188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010189 Arguments:
10190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10191 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010192
10193 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010194 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10195
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010196 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10197 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10198 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010199
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010200 - set-dst <expr> :
10201 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10202 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10203 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10204 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10205 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10206
10207 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10208 followed by some converters.
10209
10210 Example:
10211
10212 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10213 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10214
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010215 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10216 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10217
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010218 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10219 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10220 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10221 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10222
10223
10224 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10225 followed by some converters.
10226
10227 Example:
10228
10229 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10230
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010231 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10232 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10233 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10234
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010235 - "silent-drop" :
10236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010237 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010238 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10239 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10240 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10241 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10242 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010243 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10244 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010245 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10246 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010247 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010248 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10249 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10250 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10251 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010253 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10254 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10255 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010257 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10258 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10259 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010261 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010262 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010263 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010265 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10266 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10267 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010269 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010270 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10271 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010272
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010273 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10274
10275 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10276
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010277 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10278
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010279 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010280
10281
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010282tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10283 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010285 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010286 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010287 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10288 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010290 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010292 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010293 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10294 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10295 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10296 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010298 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10299 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10300 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10301 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010302 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10303 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10304 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10305 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10306 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10307 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010308 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010309 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010311 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10312 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10313 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10314 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010315
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010316 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010317 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010318 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010319 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10320 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010321 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010322 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010323 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010324 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010325 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010326 - set-dst <expr>
10327 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010328 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010329 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010330 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010331 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010332 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010333
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010334 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10335 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010336 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10337 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010338
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010339 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10340 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10341 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10342 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10343 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10344 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010346 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010347 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10348 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010350 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010351 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10352 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10353 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10354 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010355 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10356 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10357 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010358
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010359 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010360 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10361 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10362 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010363
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010364 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10365 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10366
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010367 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010368 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10369 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010370
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010371 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10372 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010373 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010374 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10375 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010376 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010377 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010378 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010379 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10380 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010381 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010382 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10383 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010384
10385 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10386 followed by some converters.
10387
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010388 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10389 <var-name>.
10390
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010391 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10392 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10393 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10394 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10395 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10396
10397 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10398 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10399 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10400 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10401 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10402 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10403 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10404 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10405 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10406 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10407 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10408
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010409 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10410 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10411 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10412 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10413 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10414
10415 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10416
10417 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10418
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010419 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10420 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10421 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10422 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10423 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10424 evaluated.
10425
10426 Example:
10427 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10428
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010429 Example:
10430
10431 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010432 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010433
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010434 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010435 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10436 # and reject everything else.
10437 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10438 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010439 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010440 tcp-request content reject
10441
10442 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010443 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10444 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10445 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010446 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010447
10448 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10449 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10450 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010451 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010452 tcp-request content reject
10453
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010454 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010455 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010456 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010457 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010458 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10459 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010460
10461 Example:
10462 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10463 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010464 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010466 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010467 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010468
10469 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010470 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010471 # protecting all our sites
10472 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010473 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10474 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010475 ...
10476 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10477
10478 backend http_dynamic
10479 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010480 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010481 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010482 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010483 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010484 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010485 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010488
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010489 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10490 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010491
10492
10493tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10494 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010496 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010497 Arguments :
10498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10500 as explained at the top of this document.
10501
10502 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10503 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10504 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10505 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10506 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10507
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010508 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10509 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10510 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10511 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10512
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010513 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10514 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010515 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010516 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010517 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10518 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10519 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10520 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010521
10522 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10523 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10524 it pass through unaffected.
10525
10526 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10527 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10528 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010529 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010530 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10531 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010532 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10533 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10534 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010536 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010537 "timeout client".
10538
10539
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010540tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10541 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10543 no | no | yes | yes
10544 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010545 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10546 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010547
10548 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10549
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010550 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010551 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10552 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010553 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10554 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010555
10556 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10557
10558 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10559 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10560 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10561 inserted.
10562
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010563 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010564 - accept :
10565 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10566 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10567 the rules evaluation.
10568
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010569 - close :
10570 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10571 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10572 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10573 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10574 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10575 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010576 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010577 protocols.
10578
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010579 - reject :
10580 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10581 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010582 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010583
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010584 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10585 Sets a variable.
10586
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010587 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10588 Unsets a variable.
10589
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010590 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10591 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10592 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10593 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10594
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010595 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10596 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10597 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10598 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10599
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010600 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10601 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10602 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10603 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10604 continues.
10605
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010606 - "silent-drop" :
10607 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010609 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10610 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10611 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10612 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10613 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010614 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10615 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010616 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10617 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010618 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010619 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10620 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10621 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10622 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10623
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010624 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10625 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10626
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010627 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10628 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10629 for changing the default action to a reject.
10630
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010631 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10632 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10633 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10634 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010635 period.
10636
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010637 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10638 declared inline.
10639
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010640 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10641 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010642 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010643 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10644 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010645 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010646 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010647 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010648 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10649 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010650 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010651 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10652 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010653
10654 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10655 followed by some converters.
10656
10657 Example:
10658
10659 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10660
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010661 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10662 <var-name>.
10663
10664 Example:
10665
10666 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10667
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010668 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10669 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10670 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10671 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10672 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10673
10674 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10675
10676 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10677
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010678 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10679
10680 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10681
10682
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010683tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10684 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10686 no | yes | yes | no
10687 Arguments :
10688 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10689 below.
10690
10691 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10692
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010693 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010694 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10695 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10696 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10697 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10698 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10699 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10700 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010701 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010702 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10703 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10704 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10705 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10706 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10707 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10708 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10709 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10710 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10711 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10712 instead.
10713
10714 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10715 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10716 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10717 rules which may be inserted.
10718
10719 Several types of actions are supported :
10720 - accept : the request is accepted
10721 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10722 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10723 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010724 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010725 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10726 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010727 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010728 - silent-drop
10729
10730 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10731 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10732 sections for a complete description.
10733
10734 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10735 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10736 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10737
10738 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10739 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10740 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10741 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10742 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10743
10744 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10745 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10746
10747 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10748 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10749 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10750
10751 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10752 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10753 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10754
10755 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10756 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10757 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10758
10759 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10760 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10761 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10762
10763 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10764
10765 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10766
10767
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010768tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10769 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10771 no | no | yes | yes
10772 Arguments :
10773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10775 as explained at the top of this document.
10776
10777 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10778
10779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010780timeout check <timeout>
10781 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10782 established.
10783
10784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10785 yes | no | yes | yes
10786 Arguments:
10787 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10789 as explained at the top of this document.
10790
10791 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10792 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010793 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010794 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010795 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10796 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10797 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010798
10799 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10800 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10801
10802 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10803 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010804 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010805
10806 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10807 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10808 forget about it.
10809
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010810 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10811 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010812
10813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010814timeout client <timeout>
10815timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10816 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10818 yes | yes | yes | no
10819 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010820 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010821 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10822 as explained at the top of this document.
10823
10824 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10825 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10826 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010827 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10828 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10829 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10830 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010831 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10832 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10833 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010834 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010835 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010836 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10837 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010838 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10839 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010840
10841 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10842 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10843 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10844 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010845 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010846 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10847
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010848 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010849
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010850 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10851 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10852 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10853
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010854 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10855 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010856
10857
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010858timeout client-fin <timeout>
10859 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10861 yes | yes | yes | no
10862 Arguments :
10863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10865 as explained at the top of this document.
10866
10867 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10868 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10869 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10870 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10871 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10872 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10873 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010874 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10875 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10876 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010877
10878 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10879 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10880 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10881
10882 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10883
10884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010885timeout connect <timeout>
10886timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10887 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10889 yes | no | yes | yes
10890 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010891 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010892 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10893 as explained at the top of this document.
10894
10895 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010896 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010897 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010898 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010899 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10900 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010901
10902 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10903 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10904 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10905 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010906 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010907 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10908
10909 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10910 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10911 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10912
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010913 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10914 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010915
10916
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010917timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10918 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10920 yes | yes | yes | yes
10921 Arguments :
10922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10924 as explained at the top of this document.
10925
10926 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10927 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10928 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10929 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10930 once the request has started to present itself.
10931
10932 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10933 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10934 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10935 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10936 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10937
10938 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10939 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10940 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10941 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10942
10943 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10944 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010945 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010946 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10947 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010948 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010949
10950 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10951 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10952 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10953 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10954
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010955 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10956 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010957 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10958
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010959 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10960
10961
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010962timeout http-request <timeout>
10963 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010966 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010967 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010968 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10969 as explained at the top of this document.
10970
10971 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10972 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10973 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10974 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10975 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10976 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10977 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010978 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10979 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10980 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10981 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010982 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010983 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10984 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010985
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010986 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10987 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10988 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10989 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10990 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010991 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010992
10993 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10994 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010996 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10997 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10998
10999 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011000 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11001 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11002 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011003
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011004 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011005 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011006
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011007
11008timeout queue <timeout>
11009 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11011 yes | no | yes | yes
11012 Arguments :
11013 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11015 as explained at the top of this document.
11016
11017 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11018 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11019 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11020 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11021 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11022
11023 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11024 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11025 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11026 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11027
11028 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11029
11030
11031timeout server <timeout>
11032timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11033 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11035 yes | no | yes | yes
11036 Arguments :
11037 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11038 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11039 as explained at the top of this document.
11040
11041 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11042 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11043 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11044 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11045 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11046 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11047 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11048
11049 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11050 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11051 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11052 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11053 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011054 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011055 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011056 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11057 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011058 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11059 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011060
11061 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11062 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11063 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11064 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011065 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011066 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11067
11068 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11069 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11070 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11071
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011072 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011073
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011074
11075timeout server-fin <timeout>
11076 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11078 yes | no | yes | yes
11079 Arguments :
11080 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11081 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11082 as explained at the top of this document.
11083
11084 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11085 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11086 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11087 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11088 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11089 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11090 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11091 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11092 situations, it should not be needed.
11093
11094 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11095 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11096 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11097
11098 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11099
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011100
11101timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011102 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11104 yes | yes | yes | yes
11105 Arguments :
11106 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11107 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11108 as explained at the top of this document.
11109
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011110 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11111 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11112 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11113 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011114
11115 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11116 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11117 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11118 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011119 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011120
11121 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11122
11123
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011124timeout tunnel <timeout>
11125 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11127 yes | no | yes | yes
11128 Arguments :
11129 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11130 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11131 as explained at the top of this document.
11132
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011133 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011134 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11135 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11136 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011137 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11138 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011139 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11140 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11141 specified.
11142
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011143 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11144 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11145 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11146 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11147 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11148 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11149 state.
11150
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011151 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11152 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11153 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11154 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011155 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011156
11157 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11158 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11159 forget about it.
11160
11161 Example :
11162 defaults http
11163 option http-server-close
11164 timeout connect 5s
11165 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011166 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011167 timeout server 30s
11168 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11169
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011170 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011171
11172
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011173transparent (deprecated)
11174 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011176 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011177 Arguments : none
11178
11179 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11180 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11181 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11182 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11183 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11184 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11185 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11186 appropriate server.
11187
11188 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11189
11190 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11191 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11192
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011193 See also: "option transparent"
11194
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011195unique-id-format <string>
11196 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11198 yes | yes | yes | no
11199 Arguments :
11200 <string> is a log-format string.
11201
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011202 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11203 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11204 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11205 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011207 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11208 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11209 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11210 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11211 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11212 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11213 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11214 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011216 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11217 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011218
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011219 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011220
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011221 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011222
11223 will generate:
11224
11225 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11226
11227 See also: "unique-id-header"
11228
11229unique-id-header <name>
11230 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11232 yes | yes | yes | no
11233 Arguments :
11234 <name> is the name of the header.
11235
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011236 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11237 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011238
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011239 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011240
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011241 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011242 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11243
11244 will generate:
11245
11246 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11247
11248 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011249
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011250use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011251 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11253 no | yes | yes | no
11254 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011255 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11256 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011257
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011258 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11259 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011260
11261 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11262 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11263 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011264 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011265 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011266 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11267 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011268
11269 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11270 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11271 assign the backend.
11272
11273 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11274 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11275 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11276 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11277 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11278 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11279
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011280 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011281 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011282 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11283 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11284 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11285
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011286 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11287 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11288 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11289 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11290 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11291 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11292 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11293 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11294 cannot be forced from the request.
11295
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011296 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011297 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11298 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11299
11300 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11301 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011302
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011303
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011304use-server <server> if <condition>
11305use-server <server> unless <condition>
11306 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11308 no | no | yes | yes
11309 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011310 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011311
11312 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11313
11314 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11315 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11316 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11317
11318 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11319 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11320 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11321 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11322 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11323 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11324 matches will assign the server.
11325
11326 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11327 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11328 with the next rules until one matches.
11329
11330 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11331 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11332 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11333 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11334
11335 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11336 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11337 stripped.
11338
11339 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11340 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11341 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11342 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11343
11344 Example :
11345 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11346 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11347 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11348 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11349 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11350 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011351 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011352 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11353 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11354
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011355 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011356
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011357
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113585. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011359--------------------------
11360
11361The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11362depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11363settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11364written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11365described in this section.
11366
11367
113685.1. Bind options
11369-----------------
11370
11371The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11372as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11373no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11374parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11375while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11376provided immediately after the setting name.
11377
11378The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11379
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011380accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11381 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11382 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11383 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11384 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11385 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11386 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11387 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11388 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11389 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011390 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11391 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11392 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011394accept-proxy
11395 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011396 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11397 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011398 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11399 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11400 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11401 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011402 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011403 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11404 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011405 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11406 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011407
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011408allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011409 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011410 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011411 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011412 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11413 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011414
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011415alpn <protocols>
11416 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11417 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11418 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011419 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011420 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011421 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11422 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11423 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11424 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11425 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11426 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11427 preference, like below :
11428
11429 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011430
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011431backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011432 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011433 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11434
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011435curves <curves>
11436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11437 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11438 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11439 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11440 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11441 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11442
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011443ecdhe <named curve>
11444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011445 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11446 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011447
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011448ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011449 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11450 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11451 client's certificate.
11452
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011453ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11455 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11456 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11457 error is ignored.
11458
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011459ca-sign-file <cafile>
11460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11461 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11462 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11463 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11464 'generate-certificates' for details.
11465
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011466ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11468 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11469 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11470 'generate-certificates' for details.
11471
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011472ciphers <ciphers>
11473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11474 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011475 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011476 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011477 information and recommendations see e.g.
11478 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11479 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11480 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11481
11482ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11484 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11485 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11486 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011487 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11488 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011489
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011490crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11492 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11493 to verify client's certificate.
11494
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011495crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11497 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11498 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11499 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11500 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11501 file.
11502
11503 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11504 are loaded.
11505
11506 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011507 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011508 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11509 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11510 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11511 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011512 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11513 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011514 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011515
11516 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11517 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11518 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11519 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011520 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11521 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011522
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011523 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011525 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011526 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011527 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11528 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011529 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11530 clients).
11531
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011532 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11533 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11534 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11535 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11536 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11537 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11538 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11539 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11540 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11541 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11542 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11543 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11544 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11545
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011546 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11547 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11548 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11549 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11550 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11551
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011552 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11553 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11554 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11555 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011556
11557 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11558 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11559 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11560 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11561 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11562 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11563 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11564 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11565 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11566
11567 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11568
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011569 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011570 a cert bundle.
11571
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011572 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011573 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11574 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11575 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11576 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11577 provide multi-cert support.
11578
11579 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11580
11581 Filename | CN | SAN
11582 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11583 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011584 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011585 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11586 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11587
11588 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11589 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11590 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11591 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011592 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11593 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11594 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011595
11596 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11597 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11598
11599 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11600 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11601 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11602
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011603crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011604 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011605 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011606 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011607 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011608
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011609crt-list <file>
11610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011611 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11612 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011613
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011614 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11615
William Lallemand0b77c182020-06-30 16:11:36 +020011616 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ciphers",
11617 "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names", "npn",
11618 "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
11619 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
11620 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011621
William Lallemandb0b703f2020-10-06 17:06:11 +020011622 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filters can be specified
11623 in the configuration, but they are only used as a hint, they don't do
11624 anything. (this changes in newer haproxy versions) If you want to exclude a
11625 SNI from a wildcard, use this positive SNI on another line. (like in the
11626 example).
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011627 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11628 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11629 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11630 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11631 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11632 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011633
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011634 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011635 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011636 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11637 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11638 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011639
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011640 crt-list file example:
11641 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011642 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011643 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011644 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011645
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011646defer-accept
11647 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11648 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11649 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011650 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011651 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11652 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11653 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11654 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11655 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11656 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11657 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11658
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011659expose-fd listeners
11660 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11661 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011662 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11663 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011664 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011665
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011666force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011667 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011668 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011669 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011670 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011671
11672force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011673 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011674 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011675 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011676
11677force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011678 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011679 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011680 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011681
11682force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011684 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011686
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011687force-tlsv13
11688 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11689 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011691
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011692generate-certificates
11693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11694 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11695 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11696 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11697 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11698 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11699 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11700 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11701 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11702 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11703 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11704
11705 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11706 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011707 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011708 certificate is used many times.
11709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011710gid <gid>
11711 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11712 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11713 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11714 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11715 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11716
11717group <group>
11718 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11719 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11720 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11721 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11722 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11723
11724id <id>
11725 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11726 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11727 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11728 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11729
11730interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011731 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11732 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11733 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11734 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11735 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11736 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011737 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11738 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11739 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11740 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11741 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11742 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011743
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011744level <level>
11745 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11746 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11747 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011748 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011749 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11750 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11751 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011752 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011753 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011754 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011755 all counters).
11756
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011757severity-output <format>
11758 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11759 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11760 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11761 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11762 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11763 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11764 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11765 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11766 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11767 rfc5424 convention.
11768
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011769maxconn <maxconn>
11770 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11771 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11772 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11773 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11774 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11775 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11776 eat all memory.
11777
11778mode <mode>
11779 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11780 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11781 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11782 UNIX sockets.
11783
11784mss <maxseg>
11785 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11786 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11787 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11788 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11789 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11790 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11791 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11792 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11793 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11794 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11795 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11796
11797name <name>
11798 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11799 page.
11800
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011801namespace <name>
11802 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11803 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11804 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11805 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11806
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011807nice <nice>
11808 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11809 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11810 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11811 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11812 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11813 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11814 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11815 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11816 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11817 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11818 one for an RDP socket.
11819
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011820no-ca-names
11821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11822 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11823
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011824no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011826 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011827 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011828 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011829 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11830 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011831
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011832no-tls-tickets
11833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11834 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11835 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011836 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11837 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011838 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11839 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11840 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011841
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011842no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011844 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011845 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011846 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011847 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11848 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011849
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011850no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011852 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011853 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011854 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011855 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11856 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011857
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011858no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011860 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011861 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011862 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011863 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11864 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011865
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011866no-tlsv13
11867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11868 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11869 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11870 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011871 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11872 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011873
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011874npn <protocols>
11875 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11876 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11877 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011878 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011879 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011880 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11881 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11882 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11883 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11884 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011885
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011886prefer-client-ciphers
11887 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11888 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11889 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011890 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11891 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11892 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011893
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011894process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011895 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011896 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011897 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011898 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11899 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11900 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11901 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011902 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011903 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11904 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11905 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11906 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11907 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011908
11909 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11910
11911 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11912 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11913 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11914 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11915 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11916 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11917 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11918 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011919
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011920proto <name>
11921 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11922 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11923 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11924 in haproxy -vv.
11925 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11926 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011927 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011928 h2" on the bind line.
11929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011930ssl
11931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011932 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011933 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11934 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011935 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11936 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011937
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011938ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11939 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11940 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11941 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11942
11943ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11944 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11945 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11946 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11947
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011948strict-sni
11949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11950 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11951 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11952 See the "crt" option for more information.
11953
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011954tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011955 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011956 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11957 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011958 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011959 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11960 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11961 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11962 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11963 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11964 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11965 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11966
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011967tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011968 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011969 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11970 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11971 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11972 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11973 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11974 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11975 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011976 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11977 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11978 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011979
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011980tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11981 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011982 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11983 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11984 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11985 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11986 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11987 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11988 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11989 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11990 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11991 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011992 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11993 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11994
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011995transparent
11996 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11997 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11998 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11999 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12000 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12001 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12002 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12003 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12004 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12005 so check for support with your vendor.
12006
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012007v4v6
12008 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12009 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12010 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12011 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012012 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012013
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012014v6only
12015 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12016 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12017 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012018 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12019 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012020
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012021uid <uid>
12022 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12023 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12024 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12025 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12026 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12027
12028user <user>
12029 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12030 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12031 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12032 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12033 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12034
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012035verify [none|optional|required]
12036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12037 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12038 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12039 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12040 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012041 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12042 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12043 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12044 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120465.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012047------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012049The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12050which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12051arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12052settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12053after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12054Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12055address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012057 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012058 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012059
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012060Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12061keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012063The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012064
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012065addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012066 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012067 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12068 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12069 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12070 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12071 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012072
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012073agent-check
12074 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012075 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012076 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12077 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12078 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012079
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012080 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012081 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012082 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12083 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12084 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012086 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12087 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12088 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12089 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12090 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012091
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012092 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012093 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012094
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012095 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12096 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12097 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012098
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012099 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12100 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12101 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012102
William Dauchyd58def32020-09-26 13:35:51 +020012103 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012104 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12105 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12106 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12107 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012108 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012109 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012110
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012111 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12112 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012113
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012114 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12115 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12116 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12117 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12118 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12119 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12120 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12121 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12122 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012123
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012124 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12125 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012126 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12127 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12128 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012129 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012130
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012131 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012132 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012133
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012134agent-send <string>
12135 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12136 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12137 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12138 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12139 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12140
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012141agent-inter <delay>
12142 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12143 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12144
12145 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12146 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12147 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12148 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12149 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12150 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12151 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12152 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12153 of backends use the same servers.
12154
12155 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12156
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012157agent-addr <addr>
12158 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12159
12160 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12161 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12162 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12163 hostname, it will be resolved.
12164
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012165agent-port <port>
12166 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12167
12168 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12169
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012170allow-0rtt
12171 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012172 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12173 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012174
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012175alpn <protocols>
12176 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12177 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12178 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012179 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012180 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12181 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12182 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12183 now obsolete NPN extension.
12184 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12185 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12186
12187 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012189backup
12190 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12191 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12192 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12193 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012194 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12195 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012196
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012197ca-file <cafile>
12198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12199 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12200 server's certificate.
12201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012202check
12203 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012204 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12205 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12206 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12207 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12208 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12209 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12210 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012211 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12212 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012213 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12214 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012215
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012216check-send-proxy
12217 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12218 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12219 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12220 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12221 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12222 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12223 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12224
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012225check-alpn <protocols>
12226 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12227 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12228 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12229
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012230check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012231 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012232 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12233 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012234
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012235check-ssl
12236 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12237 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12238 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12239 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012240 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012241 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12242 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012243 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012244 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12245 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012246
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012247check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012248 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012249 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12250 for normal traffic.
12251
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012252ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12254 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12255 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012256 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12257 information and recommendations see e.g.
12258 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12259 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12260 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012261
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012262ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12264 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12265 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12266 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012267 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12268 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12269 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012271cookie <value>
12272 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12273 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12274 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12275 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12276 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12277 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12278 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12279
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012280crl-file <crlfile>
12281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12282 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12283 to verify server's certificate.
12284
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012285crt <cert>
12286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12287 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12288 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12289 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12290 certificate request.
12291
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012292disabled
12293 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12294 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12295 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12296 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12297 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012298 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012299
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012300enabled
12301 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12302 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12303 default value.
12304 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12305 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012307error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012308 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12309 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12310 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012312 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012314fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012315 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12316 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12317 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12318
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012319force-sslv3
12320 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12321 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012322 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012323 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012324
12325force-tlsv10
12326 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012327 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012328 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012329
12330force-tlsv11
12331 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012332 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012333 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012334
12335force-tlsv12
12336 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012337 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012338 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012339
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012340force-tlsv13
12341 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12342 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012343 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012345id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012346 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12347 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12348 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012349
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012350init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12351 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12352 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012353 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012354 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12355 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12356 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12357 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12358 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12359 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12360 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12361 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12362 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012363 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012364 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12365 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12366 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12367 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12368 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12369 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012370 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012371
12372 Example:
12373 defaults
12374 # never fail on address resolution
12375 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012377inter <delay>
12378fastinter <delay>
12379downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012380 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12381 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12382 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12383 between checks depending on the server state :
12384
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012385 Server state | Interval used
12386 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12387 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12388 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12389 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12390 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12391 or yet unchecked. |
12392 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12393 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12394 | "inter" otherwise.
12395 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012397 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12398 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12399 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12400 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012401 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12402 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12403 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12404 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12405 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012407maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012408 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12409 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012410 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12411 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012412 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12413 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12414 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12415 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12416
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012417 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12418 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12419 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12420 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12421 than 50 concurrent requests.
12422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012423maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012424 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12425 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12426 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12427 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12428 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12429 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12430 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12431
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012432max-reuse <count>
12433 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12434 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12435 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12436 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12437 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12438 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12439 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12440 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012442minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012443 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12444 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12445 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12446 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12447 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12448 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012449 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012450 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012451
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012452namespace <name>
12453 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12454 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12455 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12456 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12457
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012458no-agent-check
12459 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12460 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12461 default value.
12462 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12463 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12464
12465no-backup
12466 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12467 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12468 default value.
12469 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12470 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12471
12472no-check
12473 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12474 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12475 default value.
12476 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12477 "default-server" "check" setting.
12478
12479no-check-ssl
12480 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12481 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12482 default value.
12483 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12484 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12485
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012486no-send-proxy
12487 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12488 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12489 default value.
12490 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12491 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12492
12493no-send-proxy-v2
12494 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12495 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12496 default value.
12497 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12498 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12499
12500no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12501 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12502 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12503 default value.
12504 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12505 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12506
12507no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12508 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12509 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12510 default value.
12511 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12512 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12513
12514no-ssl
12515 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12516 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12517 default value.
12518 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12519 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12520
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012521no-ssl-reuse
12522 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12523 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12524 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12525 and for paranoid users.
12526
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012527no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012528 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12529 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012530 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012531
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012532 Supported in default-server: No
12533
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012534no-tls-tickets
12535 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12536 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12537 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012538 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12539 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012540 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12541 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12542 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012543 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012544
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012545no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012546 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012547 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12548 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012549 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12550 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012551 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012552
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012553 Supported in default-server: No
12554
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012555no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012556 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012557 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12558 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012559 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12560 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012561 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012562
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012563 Supported in default-server: No
12564
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012565no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012566 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012567 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12568 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012569 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12570 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012571 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012572
12573 Supported in default-server: No
12574
12575no-tlsv13
12576 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12577 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12578 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12579 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12580 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012581 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012582
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012583 Supported in default-server: No
12584
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012585no-verifyhost
12586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12588 default value.
12589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12590 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012591
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012592no-tfo
12593 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12594 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12595 default value.
12596 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12597 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12598
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012599non-stick
12600 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12601 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12602 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12603
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012604npn <protocols>
12605 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12606 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12607 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012608 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012609 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12610 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12611 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012613observe <mode>
12614 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12615 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12616 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12617 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12618 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12619 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012620 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012621
12622 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012624on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012625 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12626 Currently, four modes are available:
12627 - fastinter: force fastinter
12628 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12629 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12630 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12631 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12632
12633 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12634
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012635on-marked-down <action>
12636 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12637 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012638 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12639 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12640 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12641 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12642 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12643 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12644 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12645 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012646
12647 Actions are disabled by default
12648
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012649on-marked-up <action>
12650 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12651 Currently one action is available:
12652 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12653 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12654 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12655 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012656 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12657 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012658 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12659 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12660
12661 Actions are disabled by default
12662
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012663pool-max-conn <max>
12664 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12665 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12666 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12667 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12668 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12669 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12670
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012671pool-purge-delay <delay>
12672 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012673 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012674 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012676port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012677 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12678 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12679 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12680 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12681 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12682 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12683
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012684proto <name>
12685
12686 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12687 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12688 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12689 reported in haproxy -vv.
12690 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12691 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693redir <prefix>
12694 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12695 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12696 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12697 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12698 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12699 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12700 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12701 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012702 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012703 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012704 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12705 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12706 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12707 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12708
12709 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012711rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012712 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12713 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12714 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12715
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012716resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12717 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12718 server.
12719
12720 Available options:
12721
12722 * allow-dup-ip
12723 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12724 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12725 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12726 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12727 For such case, simply enable this option.
12728 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12729
12730 * prevent-dup-ip
12731 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12732 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12733 same fqdn.
12734 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12735
12736 Example:
12737 backend b_myapp
12738 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12739 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12740 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12741
12742 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12743 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12744 it
12745 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12746 different address
12747
12748 Default value: not set
12749
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012750resolve-prefer <family>
12751 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12752 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12753 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12754 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12755
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012756 Default value: ipv6
12757
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012758 Example:
12759
12760 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012761
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012762resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012763 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012764 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012765 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012766 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12767 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012768 configured network, another address is selected.
12769
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012770 Example:
12771
12772 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012773
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012774resolvers <id>
12775 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12776 hostname.
12777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012778 Example:
12779
12780 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012781
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012782 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012783
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012784send-proxy
12785 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12786 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12787 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12788 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012789 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12790 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12791 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12792 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12793 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12794 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12795 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12796 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12797 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12798 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012799 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12800 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012801
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012802send-proxy-v2
12803 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12804 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12805 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12806 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012807 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12808 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12809 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12810 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012811
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012812proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12813 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12814 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012815 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12816 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012817 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12818 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012819 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012820
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012821send-proxy-v2-ssl
12822 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12823 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12824 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12825 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12826 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12827 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12828 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012829 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12830 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012831
12832send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12833 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12834 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12835 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12836 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12837 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12838 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12839 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12840 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012841 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12842 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012844slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012845 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12846 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12847 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12848 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12849 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12850 parameters :
12851
12852 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12853 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12854
12855 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12856 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12857 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12858 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12859
12860 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12861 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12862 seen as failed.
12863
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012864sni <expression>
12865 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12866 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12867 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12868 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012869 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12870 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012871 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012872 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12873 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012874
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012875source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012876source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012877source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012878 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12879 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12880 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12881 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12882
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012883 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12884 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12885 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12886 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12887 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12888 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12889 server.
12890
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012891 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12892 specifying the source address without port(s).
12893
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012894ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012895 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12896 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12897 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12898 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12899 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12900 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012901 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12902 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012903
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012904ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12905 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12906 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12907 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12908
12909ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12910 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12911 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12912 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12913
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012914ssl-reuse
12915 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12916 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12917 default value.
12918 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12919 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12920
12921stick
12922 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12923 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12924 default value.
12925 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12926 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012927
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012928socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012929 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012930 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12931 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12932
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012933tcp-ut <delay>
12934 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12935 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12936 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012937 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012938 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12939 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12940 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12941 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12942 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12943 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12944 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12945 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12946 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12947
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012948tfo
12949 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12950 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12951 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12952 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12953 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012954 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012956track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012957 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12958 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12959 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12960 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012961 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12962
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012963tls-tickets
12964 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12965 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12966 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012967 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12968 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12969 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012970 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012971 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012972
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012973verify [none|required]
12974 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012975 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012976 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12977 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012978 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012979 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12980 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12981 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12982 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12983 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12984 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12985 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12986 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012987
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012988verifyhost <hostname>
12989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012990 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12991 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12992 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12993 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12994 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12995 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12996 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12997 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012999weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013000 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13001 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13002 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013003 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13004 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13005 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13006 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13007 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13008 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013009
13010
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130115.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13012-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013013
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013014HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13015using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070013016configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013017This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13018can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13019workload.
13020This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13021resolution at run time.
13022Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13023carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13024
13025
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130265.3.1. Global overview
13027----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013028
13029As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13030different steps of the process life:
13031
13032 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13033 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13034 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13035
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013036 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13037 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013038
13039A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13040 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13041 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13042 resolution to know this new IP.
13043
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013044When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013045HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013046SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13047from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13048will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13049will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013050
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013051A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013052 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013053 first valid response.
13054
13055 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13056 servers return an error.
13057
13058
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130595.3.2. The resolvers section
13060----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013061
13062This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013063HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13064contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013065
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013066When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13067uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13068is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13069answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13070
13071When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013072used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013073
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013074 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13075 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13076 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013077
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013078 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13079 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013080
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013081 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13082 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13083 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013084
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013085For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13086following scenarios are possible:
13087
13088 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13089 ignored
13090
13091 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13092 applied
13093
13094 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13095 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13096
13097 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13098 retries the query with a new type
13099
13100 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13101 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013102
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013103As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13104a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013105<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013106
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013107
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013108resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013109 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013110
13111A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13112
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013113accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013114 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013115 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013116 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13117 by RFC 6891)
13118
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013119 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13120
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013121nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13122 DNS server description:
13123 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13124 <ip> : IP address of the server
13125 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13126
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013127parse-resolv-conf
13128 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13129 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13130 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13131
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013132hold <status> <period>
13133 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13134 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013135 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013136 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013137 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13138 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13139 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13140
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013141 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013142
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013143resolve_retries <nb>
13144 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13145 giving up.
13146 Default value: 3
13147
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013148 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13149 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13150 type.
13151
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013152timeout <event> <time>
13153 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13154 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13155 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013156 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13157 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013158 Default value: 1s
13159 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013160 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013161 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013162 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13163 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13164
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013165 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013166
13167 resolvers mydns
13168 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13169 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013170 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013171 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013172 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013173 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013174 hold other 30s
13175 hold refused 30s
13176 hold nx 30s
13177 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013178 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013179 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013180
13181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131826. HTTP header manipulation
13183---------------------------
13184
13185In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13186response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13187request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13188which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013189against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013191If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13192to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13193but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13194HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13195stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13196because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13197a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13198still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013200This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13201in section 4.2 :
13202
13203 - reqadd <string>
13204 - reqallow <search>
13205 - reqiallow <search>
13206 - reqdel <search>
13207 - reqidel <search>
13208 - reqdeny <search>
13209 - reqideny <search>
13210 - reqpass <search>
13211 - reqipass <search>
13212 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13213 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13214 - reqtarpit <search>
13215 - reqitarpit <search>
13216 - rspadd <string>
13217 - rspdel <search>
13218 - rspidel <search>
13219 - rspdeny <search>
13220 - rspideny <search>
13221 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13222 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13223
13224With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13225is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13226parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13227prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13228Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13229
13230 \t for a tab
13231 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13232 \n for a new line (LF)
13233 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13234 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13235 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13236 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13237 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13238
13239The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13240portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13241above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13242regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132439 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13244is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13245
13246The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13247after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13248
13249Notes related to these keywords :
13250---------------------------------
13251 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13252 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13253 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13254
13255 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13256 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13257 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13258
13259 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13260 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13261 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13262 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13263 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13264
13265 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13266 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13267 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13268 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13269 useless headers before adding new ones.
13270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013271 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013272 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13273
13274 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13275 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13276 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13277
13278 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13279 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013280 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013281
13282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132837. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13284----------------------------------
13285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013286HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13288The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13289these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13290but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13291data called patterns.
13292
13293
132947.1. ACL basics
13295---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013296
13297The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13298content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13299from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13300simple :
13301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013303 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13305 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13308adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013309
13310In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013312 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013313
13314This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13315Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13316and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013317an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13318conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13319as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13320are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013321
13322ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13323'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13324which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13325
13326There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13327performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013329The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13330specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13331this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013332methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13333ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334
13335Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13336 - boolean
13337 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13338 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13339 - string
13340 - data block
13341
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013342Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13343converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13344would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13345The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13346which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13347
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013348Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13349keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13350fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13351which are summarized in the table below :
13352
13353 +---------------------+-----------------+
13354 | Sample or converter | Default |
13355 | output type | matching method |
13356 +---------------------+-----------------+
13357 | boolean | bool |
13358 +---------------------+-----------------+
13359 | integer | int |
13360 +---------------------+-----------------+
13361 | ip | ip |
13362 +---------------------+-----------------+
13363 | string | str |
13364 +---------------------+-----------------+
13365 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13366 +---------------------+-----------------+
13367
13368Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13369matching method, see below.
13370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13372 - boolean
13373 - integer or integer range
13374 - IP address / network
13375 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13376 - regular expression
13377 - hex block
13378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013379The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13380
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013381 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13382 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013384 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013385 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013386 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013387 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013389The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13390read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13391if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13392lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13393will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13394beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13395a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13396lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13397exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13398
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013399The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13400parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13401ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13402a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13403check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13404
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013405The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13406socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13407file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13410loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13411
13412 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13413
13414In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13415the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13416case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13417as well.
13418
13419The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13420sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13421do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13422methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13423is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013424obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13426default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13427that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13428string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13429
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013430The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13431By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13432string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13433resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13434server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013435waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013436flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13437function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13440sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13441be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013442
13443 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13444 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13446 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13447 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13448 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013449
13450 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13451 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013453
13454 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013456
13457 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013460 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013461 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13462
13463 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13464 binary or string samples.
13465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13467 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13470 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13471 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13474 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13477 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013479 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13480 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013482 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13483 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013484 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13487 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13488 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013489
13490For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13491request, it is possible to do :
13492
13493 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13494
13495In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13496buffer, one would use the following acl :
13497
13498 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13499
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013500On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13501possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13502
13503 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13506criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13507method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13508to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13509criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13510the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013512If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013513the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13514For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013516 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13517 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13518 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13519 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013520
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013521
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013522The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13523types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13524combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13525brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13526default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013528 +-------------------------------------------------+
13529 | Input sample type |
13530 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013531 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013532 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13533 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13534 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013535 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013536 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013537 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013538 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013539 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013541 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013543 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013545 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013547 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013549 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013550 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013551 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013553 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013555 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13557 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013559
13560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135617.1.1. Matching booleans
13562------------------------
13563
13564In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13565Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13566When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13567that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13568
13569Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13570return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13571"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135747.1.2. Matching integers
13575------------------------
13576
13577Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13578enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13579to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13580
13581Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13582matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13583lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013584
13585For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13586unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13587representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13588
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013589As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13590two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13591instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13592ranges and operators.
13593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013594For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013595operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13596Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13597of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013599Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013600
13601 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13602 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13603 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13604 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13605 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013607For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013608
13609 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13610
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013611This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13612
13613 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136167.1.3. Matching strings
13617-----------------------
13618
13619String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13620different forms :
13621
13622 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013623 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624
13625 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013626 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013627
13628 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13629 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13630
13631 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13632 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13633
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013634 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13636 matches.
13637
13638 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13639 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13640 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013641
13642String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13643exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13644characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13645string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13646to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013647before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013648
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013649Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13650(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13651Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13652
13653Example:
13654 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13655 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136587.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13659---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013660
13661Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13662they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13663possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13664passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13665the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013666the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13667match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013668
13669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13671-------------------------------------
13672
13673It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13674not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13675a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13676to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13677digits may be used upper or lower case.
13678
13679Example :
13680 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13681 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13682
13683
136847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13685---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013686
13687IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13688netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13689within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013690host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013691difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13692at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13693does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13694parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013695
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013696The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13697abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13698
13699 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13700 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13701 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13702 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13703 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13704 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13705 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13706 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13707
13708Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13709192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13710
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013711IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13712Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13713trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13714IPv6 patterns.
13715
13716HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13717following situations :
13718 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13719 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13720 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13721 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13722 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13723 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13724 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13725 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13726 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13727 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013729
137307.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13731----------------------------------
13732
13733Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13734combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13735
13736 - AND (implicit)
13737 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13738 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013740A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013744Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13745indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13748"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13749requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13750is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13751
13752 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013753 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13754 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13755 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756
13757To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13758and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13759
13760 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13761 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13762 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13763 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13764
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013765 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013766 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13767 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13768 use_backend www if host_www
13769
13770It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13771expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13772be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13773the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13774
13775 The following rule :
13776
13777 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013778 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013779
13780 Can also be written that way :
13781
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013782 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013783
13784It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13785to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13786simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13787sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13788good use is the following :
13789
13790 With named ACLs :
13791
13792 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13793 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13794 monitor fail if site_dead
13795
13796 With anonymous ACLs :
13797
13798 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13799
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013800See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13801keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802
13803
138047.3. Fetching samples
13805---------------------
13806
13807Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13808against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13809sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13810ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13811of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13812available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13813
13814This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13815Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13816compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13817deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13818
13819The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13820matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13821method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13822indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13823
13824As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13825when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13826mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13827the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13828ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13829
13830Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13831multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13832when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013833incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13834are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13836all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13837
13838Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13839 - name
13840 - name(arg1)
13841 - name(arg1,arg2)
13842
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013843
138447.3.1. Converters
13845-----------------
13846
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013847Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13848of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13849is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13850was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013852unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13853
13854These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13855sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13856the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013857support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013858
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013859A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13860support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13861supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13862(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13863bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013865The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013866
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001386751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13868 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13869 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13870 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13871 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13872 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13873
13874 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013875 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13876 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013877 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13878 frontend http-in
13879 bind *:8081
13880 default_backend servers
13881 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13882 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13883
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013884add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013885 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013886 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013887 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13888 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013889 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013890 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13891 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13892 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13893 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013894 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013895 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013896
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013897aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13898 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13899 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13900 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13901 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13902 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13903 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13904
13905 Example:
13906 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13907 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13908
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013909and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013910 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013911 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013912 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13913 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13916 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13917 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13918 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013919 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013920 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013921
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013922b64dec
13923 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13924 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13925
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013926base64
13927 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013928 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013929 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13930
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013931bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013932 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013933 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013934 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013935 presence of a flag).
13936
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013937bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13938 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13939 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013940 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013941
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013942concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13943 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13944 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13945 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13946 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13947 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13948 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13949 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13950 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13951 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13952 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013953 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013954 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013955 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013956
13957 Example:
13958 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13959 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13960 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13961 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13962
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013963cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013964 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13965 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013966
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013967crc32([<avalanche>])
13968 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13969 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13970 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13971 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13972 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13973 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13974 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13975 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13976 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13977 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013978 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13979
13980crc32c([<avalanche>])
13981 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13982 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13983 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13984 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13985 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13986 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13987 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13988 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013989
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013990da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013991 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13992 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13993 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13994 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013995 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013996 configuration language.
13997
13998 Example:
13999 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014000 bind *:8881
14001 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014002 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014003
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014004debug
14005 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
14006 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
14007 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
14008
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014009div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014010 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14011 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014012 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014013 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14014 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14017 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14018 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14019 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014021 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014022
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014023djb2([<avalanche>])
14024 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14025 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14026 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14027 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14028 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14029 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14030 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014031 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14032 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014033
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014034even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014035 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014036 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14037
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014038field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14039 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14040 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14041 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14042 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14043 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14044 fields.
14045
14046 Example :
14047 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14048 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14049 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14050 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14051 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014053hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014054 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014055 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014056 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014057 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014058
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014059hex2i
14060 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014061 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014062
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014063http_date([<offset>])
14064 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14065 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14066 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14067 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14068 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14069 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014071in_table(<table>)
14072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14074 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014075 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014076 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14077
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014078ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14079 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014080 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014081 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14082 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14083 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14084 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14085 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014086
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014087json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014088 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014089 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014090 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014091 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14092 of errors:
14093 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14094 bytes, ...)
14095 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14096 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14097
14098 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14099 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14100 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14101 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14102 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14103 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 - "ascii" : never fails;
14105 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14106 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014107 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014108 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014109 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14110 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14111
14112 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014113 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014114
14115 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014116 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014117 capture request header user-agent len 150
14118 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014119
14120 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14121 GET / HTTP/1.0
14122 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14123
14124 Output log:
14125 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14126
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014127language(<value>[,<default>])
14128 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14129 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14130 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14131 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14132 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14133 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14134 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14135 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14136 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014138 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14139 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014141 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014142
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014143 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14144 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014145
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014146 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14147 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14148 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14149 use_backend spanish if es
14150 use_backend french if fr
14151 use_backend english if en
14152 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014153
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014154length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014155 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14156 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14157 type. The result is of type integer.
14158
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014159lower
14160 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14161 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14162 type. The result is of type string.
14163
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014164ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14165 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14166 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14167 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14168 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14169 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14170 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14171
14172 Example :
14173
14174 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014175 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014176 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14177
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014178map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14179map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14180map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14181 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14182 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14183 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14184 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14185 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14186 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14187 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14188 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014189
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014190 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14191 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14192 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014193
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014194 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014195 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014197 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14198 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14199 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14200 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014201 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14202 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014203 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14204 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14205 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14206 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14207 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14208 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14209 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14210 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014211 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14212 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14213 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014214 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14215 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14216 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14217 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14218 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014219
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014220 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14221 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14222 the corresponding match text.
14223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014224 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14225 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14226 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14227 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14228 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014229
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014230 Example :
14231
14232 # this is a comment and is ignored
14233 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14234 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14235 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14236 | | | `---------- value
14237 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14238 | `---------------------------- key
14239 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14240
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014241mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014242 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14243 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014244 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014245 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014253
14254mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014255 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014256 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14257 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014258 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014259 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14262 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14263 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14264 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014266 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014267
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014268nbsrv
14269 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14270 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14271 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14272 map lookup.
14273
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014274neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014275 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14276 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14277 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14278 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014279
14280not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014281 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014282 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014283 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014284 absence of a flag).
14285
14286odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014287 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014288 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14289
14290or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014291 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014292 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014293 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14294 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014295 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014296 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14297 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14299 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014301 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014302
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014303protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14304 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14305 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14306 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14307 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14308 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14309 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14310 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14311 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14312 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14313 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14314 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14315
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014316regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014317 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14318 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14319 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14320 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14321 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14322 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14323 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14324 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14325 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14326 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014327 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14328 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14329 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14330 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014331
14332 Example :
14333
14334 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14335 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14336 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14337 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14338
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014339capture-req(<id>)
14340 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14341 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14342
14343 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014344 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14345 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014346
14347capture-res(<id>)
14348 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14349 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14350
14351 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014352 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14353 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014354
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014355sdbm([<avalanche>])
14356 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14357 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14358 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14359 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14360 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14361 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14362 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014363 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14364 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014365
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014366set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014367 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14368 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14369 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014370 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014371 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14372 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014373 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014378
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014379sha1
14380 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14381 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14382
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014383strcmp(<var>)
14384 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14385 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14386 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14387 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14388 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14389 shorter).
14390
14391 Example :
14392
14393 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14394 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14395 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14396
14397
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014398sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014399 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14400 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014401 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014402 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14403 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014404 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014405 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14406 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014407 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014408 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14409 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014410 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014411 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014412
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014413table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14414 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14415 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14416 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14417 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14418 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14419 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14420
14421
14422table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14423 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14424 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14425 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14426 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14427 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14428 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14429
14430table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14431 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14432 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014433 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014434 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14435 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14436
14437table_conn_cur(<table>)
14438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14441 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14442 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14443
14444table_conn_rate(<table>)
14445 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14446 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14447 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14448 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14449 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14450
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014451table_gpt0(<table>)
14452 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14453 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14454 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14455 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14456 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14457
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014458table_gpc0(<table>)
14459 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14460 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14461 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14462 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14463 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14464
14465table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14468 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14469 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14470 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14471 sample fetch keyword.
14472
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014473table_gpc1(<table>)
14474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14477 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14478 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14479
14480table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14481 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14482 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14483 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14484 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14485 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14486 sample fetch keyword.
14487
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014488table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14489 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14490 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014491 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014492 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14493 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14494
14495table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14496 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14497 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14498 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14499 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14500 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14501 keyword.
14502
14503table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14504 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14505 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014506 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014507 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14508 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14509
14510table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14511 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14512 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14513 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14514 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14515 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14516 keyword.
14517
14518table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014521 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014522 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14523 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14524 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14525 keyword.
14526
14527table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14528 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14529 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014530 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014531 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14532 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14533 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14534 keyword.
14535
14536table_server_id(<table>)
14537 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14538 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14539 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14540 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14541 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14542 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14543
14544table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14545 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14546 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014547 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014548 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14549 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14550 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14551 keyword.
14552
14553table_sess_rate(<table>)
14554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14556 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14557 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14558 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14559 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14560 keyword.
14561
14562table_trackers(<table>)
14563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14565 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14566 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14567 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14568 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14569 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14570 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14571 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14572 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14573
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014574upper
14575 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14576 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14577 type. The result is of type string.
14578
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014579url_dec([<in_form>])
14580 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14581 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14582 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14583 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14584 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14585 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014586
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014587ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014588 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014589 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14590 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14591 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014592 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14593 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14594 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14595 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014596 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014597 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14598 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014599
14600 Example:
14601 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14602 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14603
14604 message Point {
14605 int32 latitude = 1;
14606 int32 longitude = 2;
14607 }
14608
14609 message PPoint {
14610 Point point = 59;
14611 }
14612
14613 message Rectangle {
14614 // One corner of the rectangle.
14615 PPoint lo = 48;
14616 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14617 PPoint hi = 49;
14618 }
14619
14620 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14621 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14622 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14623
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014624 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14625 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014626 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014627 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14628
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014629 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014630
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014631 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014632
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014633 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014634 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14635 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14636
14637 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14638 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14639 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14640
14641 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14642 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14643 interpret the previous binary sample.
14644
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014645
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014646unset-var(<var name>)
14647 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14648 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14651 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14652 response),
14653 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14654 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14656 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14657
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014658utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14659 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14660 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14661 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14662 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14663 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14664 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14665
14666 Example :
14667
14668 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014669 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014670 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14671
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014672word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14673 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14674 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14675 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014676 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014677 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14678 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14679
14680 Example :
14681 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14682 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14683 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14684 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14685 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014686 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014687
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014688wt6([<avalanche>])
14689 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14690 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14691 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14692 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14693 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14694 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14695 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014696 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14697 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014698
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014699xor(<value>)
14700 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014701 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014702 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014703 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014704 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014705 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14706 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014707 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014708 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14709 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014710 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014711 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014712
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014713xxh32([<seed>])
14714 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14715 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14716 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14717 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14718 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14719 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14720 as cryptographically secure.
14721
14722xxh64([<seed>])
14723 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14724 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14725 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14726 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14727 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14728 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14729 as cryptographically secure.
14730
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147327.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733--------------------------------------------
14734
14735A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14736not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14737"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14738The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14739
14740always_false : boolean
14741 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14742 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14743
14744always_true : boolean
14745 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14746 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14747
14748avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014749 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014750 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14751 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14752 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14753 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14754 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14755 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14756 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14757 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14758 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14759 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14760 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14761 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14762 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014765 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14766 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14767 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14768 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014769 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14770
14771be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14772 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14773 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14774 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14775 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14776 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014777 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14778 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014779
14780 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14781 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14782 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14785 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14786 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14787 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014788 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14790 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014791
14792 Example :
14793 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14794 backend dynamic
14795 mode http
14796 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14797 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014799bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014800 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14801 of the string.
14802
14803bool(<bool>) : bool
14804 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14805 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014809 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14811 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014812
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014813 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014814 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014815 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14816
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014817 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14818 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014819
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014820 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014821 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014823 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014824 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014826 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014827
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014828 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14829 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014831 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014832
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014833cpu_calls : integer
14834 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14835 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14836 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14837 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14838 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14839 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14840
14841cpu_ns_avg : integer
14842 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14843 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14844 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14845 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14846 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14847 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14848 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14849 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14850 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14851 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14852 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14853
14854cpu_ns_tot : integer
14855 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14856 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14857 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14858 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14859 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14860 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14861 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14862 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14863 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14864 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14865 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14866 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14867 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14868
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014869date([<offset>]) : integer
14870 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14871 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14872 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14873 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014874 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14875
14876 Example :
14877
14878 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14879 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014880
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014881date_us : integer
14882 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14883 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14884 from the same timeval structure.
14885
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014886distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14887 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14888 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14889 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14890 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14891 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14892 list of supported tokens.
14893
14894distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14895 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14896 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14897 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14898 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14899 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14900 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14901 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14902 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14903 supported tokens.
14904
14905 Example :
14906 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14907 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14908 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14909 # send large files to the big farm
14910 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14911
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014912env(<name>) : string
14913 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14914 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14915 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14916 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14917 certain way.
14918
14919 Examples :
14920 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14921 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14922
14923 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14924 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14927 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014928 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14929 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14931 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014932 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014933 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14934 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014935
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014936fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14937 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14938 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14939 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14942 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14943 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14944 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14945 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14946 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14947 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14948 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14949 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014950
14951 Example :
14952 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14953 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14954 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14955 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14956 frontend mail
14957 bind :25
14958 mode tcp
14959 maxconn 100
14960 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14961 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14962 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14963 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014964
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014965hostname : string
14966 Returns the system hostname.
14967
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014968int(<integer>) : signed integer
14969 Returns a signed integer.
14970
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014971ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14972 Returns an ipv4.
14973
14974ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14975 Returns an ipv6.
14976
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014977lat_ns_avg : integer
14978 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14979 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14980 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14981 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14982 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14983 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14984 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14985 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14986 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14987 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14988 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14989 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14990 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14991 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14992
14993lat_ns_tot : integer
14994 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14995 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14996 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14997 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14998 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14999 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15000 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15001 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15002 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15003 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15004 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15005 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15006 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15007 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15008 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15009 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15010 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15011 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15012 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15013
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015014meth(<method>) : method
15015 Returns a method.
15016
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015017nbproc : integer
15018 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15019 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15020 and debugging purposes.
15021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15024 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15025 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015026 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15027 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15028 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015029
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015030prio_class : integer
15031 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15032 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15033 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15034
15035prio_offset : integer
15036 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15037 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15038 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15039 set-priority-offset".
15040
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015041proc : integer
15042 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15043 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15044 debugging purposes.
15045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015047 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15048 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15049 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15051 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15052 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15053 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15054 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15055
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015056rand([<range>]) : integer
15057 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15058 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15059 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15060 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15061 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15062
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015063uuid([<version>]) : string
15064 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15065 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15066 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15070 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15071 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15072 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15073 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015074 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15075 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15076
15077srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15078 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15079 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15080 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15081 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15082 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15083 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15084 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15085
15086 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15087 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088
15089srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15090 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15091 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15092 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015093 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15095 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15096 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15097
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015098srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15100 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15101 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15102 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15103 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15104 fetch methods.
15105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015106srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15107 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15108 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015109 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15111 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015112 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113 overloading servers).
15114
15115 Example :
15116 # Redirect to a separate back
15117 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15118 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15119 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15120
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015121stopping : boolean
15122 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15123 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15124 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15125
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015126str(<string>) : string
15127 Returns a string.
15128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15130 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15131 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15132
15133table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15134 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15135 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15136 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15137
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015138thread : integer
15139 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15140 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15141 and debugging purposes.
15142
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015143var(<var-name>) : undefined
15144 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015145 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15146 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015147 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015148 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15149 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015150 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015151 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015154 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015155
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151567.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157----------------------------------
15158
15159The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15160closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15161methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15162sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15163TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015164the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15165counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015166"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15167used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15168can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15169Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15170table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15171tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15172currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015174bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015175 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15176 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15177 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015179be_id : integer
15180 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15181 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15182
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015183be_name : string
15184 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15185 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187dst : ip
15188 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15189 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15190 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15191 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015192 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15193 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15194 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15195 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15196 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15197 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198
15199dst_conn : integer
15200 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15201 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15202 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15203 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15204 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15205 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15206 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15207 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015208
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015209dst_is_local : boolean
15210 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15211 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15212 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15213 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015214 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015215 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15216 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15217 it only once per connection.
15218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015219dst_port : integer
15220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15221 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15222 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15223 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15224 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15225 an HTTP header.
15226
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015227fc_http_major : integer
15228 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15229 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15230 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15231
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015232fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15233 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15234 header.
15235
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015236fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15237 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15238 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15239 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15240 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15241 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15242 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15243
15244fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15245 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15246 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15247 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15248 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15249 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15250 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15251
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015252fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015253 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15254 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15255 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15256 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15257
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015258fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015259 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15260 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15261 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15262 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15263
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015264fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015265 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15266 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15267 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15268 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15269
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015270fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015271 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15272 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15273 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15274 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15275
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015276fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015277 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15278 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15279 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15280 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15281
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015282fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015283 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15284 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15285 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15286 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15287
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015288fe_defbe : string
15289 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15290 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292fe_id : integer
15293 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015294 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15296
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015297fe_name : string
15298 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15299 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15300 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015302sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015303sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15304sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15305sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015306 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15307 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15308 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015310sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015311sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15312sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15313sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015314 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15315 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15316 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15317
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015318sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015319sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15320sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15321sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015322 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15323 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015324 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15325 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15326 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015327
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015328 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015329 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15330 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015331 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15332 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15333 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015334 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15335 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15336
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015337sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15338sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15339sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15340sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15341 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15342 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15343 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15344 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15345 when a first ACL was verified.
15346
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015347sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015348sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15349sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15350sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015351 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015352 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015354sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015355sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15356sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15357sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015358 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15359 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15360 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015362sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015363sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15364sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15365sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015366 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15367 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15368 See also src_conn_rate.
15369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015370sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015371sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15372sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15373sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015374 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015375 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015376
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015377sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15378sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15379sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15380sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15381 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15382 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15383
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015384sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15385sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15386sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15387sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15388 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15389 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15390
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015391sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015392sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15393sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015395 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15396 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15397 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015398 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15399 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15400 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015401
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015402sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15403sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15404sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15405sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15406 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15407 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15408 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15409 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15410 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15411 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015413sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015414sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15415sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15416sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015417 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015418 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15419 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15420
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015421sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015422sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15423sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15424sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015425 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15426 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15427 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15428 src_http_err_rate.
15429
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015430sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015431sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15432sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15433sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015434 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015435 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15436 src_http_req_cnt.
15437
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015438sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015439sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15440sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15441sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015442 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15443 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15444 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15445 src_http_req_rate.
15446
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015447sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015448sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15449sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15450sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015451 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015452 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15453 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15454 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15455 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015456
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015457 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015458 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15459 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015460 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15461
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015462sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15463sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15464sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15465sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15466 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15467 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15468 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15469 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15470 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15471
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015472sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015473sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15474sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15475sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015476 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15477 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15478 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015480sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015481sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15482sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15483sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015484 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15485 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15486 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015488sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015489sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15490sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15491sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015492 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015493 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15494 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15495 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015496 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015497 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015499sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015500sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15501sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15502sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015503 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15504 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15505 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15506 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15507 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015508 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015509
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015510sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015511sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15512sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15513sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015514 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15515 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15516 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015518sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015519sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15520sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15521sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015522 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15523 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015524 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015525 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15526 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15528 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15529 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531so_id : integer
15532 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15533 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15534 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015535
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015536so_name : string
15537 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15538 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15539 strings instead of integers.
15540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015542 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15544 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15545 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015546 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15547 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15548 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015549 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15550 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15551 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15552 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15553 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15554 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15555 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015556
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015557 Example:
15558 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15559 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15562 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15563 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15564 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015565 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15568 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15569 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015570 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015571 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15574 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15575 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15576 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15577 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15578 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15579 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015580
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015581 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015582 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15583 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15584 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15585 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015586 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015587 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15588 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15589
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015590src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15591 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15592 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15593 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15594 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15595 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15596 was verified.
15597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015599 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015601 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015602 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015605 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15607 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015608 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15611 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15612 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15613 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015614 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015617 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015619 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015620 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015622src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15623 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15624 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15625 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15626 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15627
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015628src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15629 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15630 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15631 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15632 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015635 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015637 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15638 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015639 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15640 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15641 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015642
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015643src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15644 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15645 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15646 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15647 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15648 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15649 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15650 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015653 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015655 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015656 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15660 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15661 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15662 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15663 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015664 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015667 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15669 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015670 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15673 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15674 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15675 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015676 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015677 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15680 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15681 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15682 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015683 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15685 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015686
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015687 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015688 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015689 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015690 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015691
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015692src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15693 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15694 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15695 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15696 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15697 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15698 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15699
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015700src_is_local : boolean
15701 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15702 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15703 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15704 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015705 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015706 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15707 once per connection.
15708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015710 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15711 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15712 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15713 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15714 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015717 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15718 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15719 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15720 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15721 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723src_port : integer
15724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15725 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15726 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15727 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015730 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015731 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15732 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15733 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015734 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15737 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15738 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15739 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15740 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015741 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15744 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15745 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15746 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15747 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15748 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15749 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15750 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15751 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015752
15753 Example :
15754 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15755 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15756 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15757 listen ssh
15758 bind :22
15759 mode tcp
15760 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015761 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015763 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765srv_id : integer
15766 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15767 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15768 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015769
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157707.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15774closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15775when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15776usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015777future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015778
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001577951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15780 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15781 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15782 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15783 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15784 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15785
15786 Example :
15787 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15788 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15789 # the request.
15790 frontend http-in
15791 bind *:8081
15792 default_backend servers
15793 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15794 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15795
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015796ssl_bc : boolean
15797 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15798 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15799 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15800
15801ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15802 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15803 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15804
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015805ssl_bc_alpn : string
15806 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15807 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015808 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015809 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15810 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15811 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15812 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15813 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15814 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15815
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015816ssl_bc_cipher : string
15817 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15818 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15819
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015820ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15821 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15822 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15823 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15824
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015825ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15826 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15827 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15828 session or a TLS ticket.
15829
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015830ssl_bc_npn : string
15831 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15832 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015833 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015834 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15835 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15836 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15837 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15838 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15839
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015840ssl_bc_protocol : string
15841 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15842 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15843
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015844ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015845 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015846 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15847 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015848
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015849ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15850 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15851 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15852 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15853
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015854ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15855 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15856 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15857 if session was reused or not.
15858
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015859ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15860 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15861 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15862 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15863 BoringSSL.
15864
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015865ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15866 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15867 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015869ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15870 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15871 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15872 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15873 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15874 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15877 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15878 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15879 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15880 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015881
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015882ssl_c_der : binary
15883 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15884 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15885 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887ssl_c_err : integer
15888 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15889 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15890 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15891 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15892 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15895 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15896 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15897 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15898 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15899 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15900 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15901 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15902 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904ssl_c_key_alg : string
15905 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15906 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15907 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909ssl_c_notafter : string
15910 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15911 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15912 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914ssl_c_notbefore : string
15915 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15916 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15917 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15920 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15921 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15922 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15923 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15924 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15925 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15926 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15927 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929ssl_c_serial : binary
15930 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15931 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15932 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15935 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15936 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15937 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015938 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15939 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15940
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015941 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015942 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15945 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15946 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15947 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949ssl_c_used : boolean
15950 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15951 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953ssl_c_verify : integer
15954 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15955 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15956 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15957 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959ssl_c_version : integer
15960 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15961 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015962
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015963ssl_f_der : binary
15964 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15965 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15966 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15969 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15970 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15971 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15972 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015973 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15975 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15976 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978ssl_f_key_alg : string
15979 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15980 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15981 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983ssl_f_notafter : string
15984 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15985 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15986 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988ssl_f_notbefore : string
15989 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15990 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15991 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15994 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15995 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15996 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15997 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15998 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15999 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16000 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16001 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003ssl_f_serial : binary
16004 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16005 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16006 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016007
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016008ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16009 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16010 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16011 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16014 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16015 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16016 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018ssl_f_version : integer
16019 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16020 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16021
16022ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016023 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16024 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16025 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027 Example :
16028 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16029 listen http-https
16030 bind :80
16031 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16032 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16033
16034ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16035 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16036 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16037
16038ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016039 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16041 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16042 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16043 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16044 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16045 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16046 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16047 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049ssl_fc_cipher : string
16050 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16051 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016052
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016053ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16054 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16055 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016056 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016057
16058ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16059 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16060 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016061 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016062
16063ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16064 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16065 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16066 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016067 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016068 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016069
16070ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16071 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16072 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016073 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016074
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016075ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16076 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16077 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16078 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016081 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16082 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016083 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16084 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16085 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16086 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016087
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016088ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16089 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16090 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16091 wait until the handshake happened.
16092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16094 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016095 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16096 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016097 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016098 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016099
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016100ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016101 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016102 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16103 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016106 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16108 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16109 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16110 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16111 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16112 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16113 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115ssl_fc_protocol : string
16116 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16117 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016118
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016119ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016120 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016121 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16122 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016123
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016124ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16125 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16126 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16127 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16130 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16131 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16132 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16133 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016134
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016135ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16136 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16137 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16138 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16139 BoringSSL.
16140
16141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142ssl_fc_sni : string
16143 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16144 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16145 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16146 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16147 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16148
16149 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16150 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16151 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016152 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016153 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16157 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16160 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16161 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016162
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161647.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016167Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16168sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16169only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16170For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16171be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16172can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16173sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16174for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16175content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016178 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16180 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16183 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016184 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187req.len : integer
16188req_len : integer (deprecated)
16189 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16190 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16191 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16192 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16193 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16194 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16195 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16196 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16199 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016200 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16201 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16202 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16203 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205 ACL alternatives :
16206 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16209 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16210 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16211 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16212 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214 ACL alternatives :
16215 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016219req.proto_http : boolean
16220req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16221 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16222 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16223 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16224 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16225 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16226 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16227 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229 Example:
16230 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16231 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16232 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016233 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16236rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16237 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16238 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16239 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16240 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16241 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16242 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16243 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16246 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16247 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16248 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16249 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16250 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 ACL derivatives :
16253 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 Example :
16256 listen tse-farm
16257 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16258 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16259 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16260 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16261 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16262 persist rdp-cookie
16263 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16264 # This is only useful makes sense if
16265 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16266 stick-table type string size 204800
16267 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16268 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16269 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16272 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16275rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16276 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16277 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16278 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16279 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281 ACL derivatives :
16282 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016283
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016284req.ssl_alpn : string
16285 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16286 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16287 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16288 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16289 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16290 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016291 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016292
16293 Examples :
16294 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16295 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16296 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016297 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016298 default_backend bk_default
16299
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016300req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16301 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16302 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016303 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16304 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16305 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16306 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16307 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016309req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16310req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16311 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16312 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16313 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16314 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16315 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16316 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16317 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319req.ssl_sni : string
16320req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16321 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16322 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16323 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16324 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16325 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16326 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16327 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16328 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16329 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16330 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16331 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16332 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334 ACL derivatives :
16335 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337 Examples :
16338 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16339 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16340 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16341 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16342 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016343
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016344req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16345 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16346 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16347 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16348 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16349 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16350 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16351 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16352 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16353 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355req.ssl_ver : integer
16356req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16357 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16358 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16359 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16360 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16361 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16362 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16363 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016364 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016367 ACL derivatives :
16368 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016369
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016370res.len : integer
16371 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16372 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16373 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16374 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16375 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16376 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16377 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16378 content inspection.
16379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16381 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016382 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16383 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16384 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16385 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16388 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16389 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16390 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16391 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016394
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016395res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16396rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16397 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16398 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16399 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16400 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16401 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16402 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16403 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405wait_end : boolean
16406 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16407 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016408 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16410 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016411 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016412 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16413 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415 Examples :
16416 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16417 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16418 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16421 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16422 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16423 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16424 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16425 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16426 tcp-request content reject
16427
16428
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164297.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430--------------------------------------
16431
16432It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16433This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16434data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16435its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16436HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16437content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16438to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16439more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16440response are indexed.
16441
16442base : string
16443 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16444 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16445 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16446 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16447 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16448 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16449 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16450 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16451
16452 ACL derivatives :
16453 base : exact string match
16454 base_beg : prefix match
16455 base_dir : subdir match
16456 base_dom : domain match
16457 base_end : suffix match
16458 base_len : length match
16459 base_reg : regex match
16460 base_sub : substring match
16461
16462base32 : integer
16463 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16464 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16465 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016466 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16467 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16468 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469
16470base32+src : binary
16471 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16472 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16473 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16474 per-URL counters.
16475
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016476capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16477 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16478 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16479 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16480
16481capture.req.method : string
16482 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16483 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16484 because it's allocated.
16485
16486capture.req.uri : string
16487 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16488 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16489 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16490 allocated.
16491
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016492capture.req.ver : string
16493 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16494 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16495 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16496
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016497capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16498 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16499 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16500 The first entry is an index of 0.
16501 See also: "capture response header"
16502
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016503capture.res.ver : string
16504 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16505 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16506 persistent flag.
16507
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016508req.body : binary
16509 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16510 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16511 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16512 the first chunk is analyzed.
16513
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016514req.body_param([<name>) : string
16515 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16516 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16517 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16518 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16519 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16520 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16521 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16522 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16523 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16524 given.
16525
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016526req.body_len : integer
16527 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16528 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16529 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16530 "option http-buffer-request".
16531
16532req.body_size : integer
16533 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16534 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16535 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16536 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16537 "option http-buffer-request".
16538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016539req.cook([<name>]) : string
16540cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16541 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16542 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16543 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16544 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16545 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16546 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16547 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16548 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16549
16550 ACL derivatives :
16551 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16552 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16553 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16554 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16555 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16556 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16557 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16558 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016560req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16561cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16562 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16563 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16566cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16567 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16568 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16569 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16570 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16573 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16574 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16575 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16576 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016577 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16579 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16580 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16581 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016583hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16584 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16585 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16586 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16587 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016588 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16591 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16592 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16593 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16594 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16595 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16596 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16597 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16598 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16601 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16602 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16603 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16604 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16607 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16608 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16609 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16610 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16611 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16612 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16613 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16614 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016615 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016617 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016619 ACL derivatives :
16620 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16621 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16622 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16623 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16624 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16625 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16626 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16627 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16628
16629req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16630hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16631 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16632 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16633 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16634 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16635 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16636 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16637 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16638 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16639 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16640
16641req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16642hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16643 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16644 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16645 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreaud08feaf2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010016646 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
16647 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
16648 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
16649 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
16650 cause the address to be ignored. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016651 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016652 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016653 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16654 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16655
16656req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16657hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16658 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16659 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16660 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16661 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16662 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16663 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16664 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16665
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016666req.hdrs : string
16667 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16668 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16669 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16670 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16671
16672req.hdrs_bin : binary
16673 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16674 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16675 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16676 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16677 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16678 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16679
16680 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016681
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016682 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16683 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016685http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16686 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16687 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16688 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16689 basic auth is supported.
16690
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016691http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16692 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16693 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16694 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16695 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016696 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16697 basic auth is supported.
16698
16699 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016700 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16701 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16702 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16703 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704
16705http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016706 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16707 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016708 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16709 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016711method : integer + string
16712 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16713 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16714 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16715 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16716 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16717 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16718 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016720 ACL derivatives :
16721 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723 Example :
16724 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16725 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16726 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728path : string
16729 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16730 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16731 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16732 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16733 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016734 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737 ACL derivatives :
16738 path : exact string match
16739 path_beg : prefix match
16740 path_dir : subdir match
16741 path_dom : domain match
16742 path_end : suffix match
16743 path_len : length match
16744 path_reg : regex match
16745 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016746
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016747query : string
16748 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16749 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16750 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16751 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016752 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016753 which stops before the question mark.
16754
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016755req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16756 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16757 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16758 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16759 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016761req.ver : string
16762req_ver : string (deprecated)
16763 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16764 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16765 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767 ACL derivatives :
16768 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770res.comp : boolean
16771 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16772 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16773 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775res.comp_algo : string
16776 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16777 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16778 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780res.cook([<name>]) : string
16781scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16782 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16783 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16784 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786 ACL derivatives :
16787 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16790scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16791 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16792 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16793 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16796scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16797 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16798 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16799 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16802 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16803 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16804 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16805 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16806 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16807 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16808 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16809 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16810 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16813 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16814 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16815 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16816 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16817 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16820shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16821 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16822 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16823 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16824 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16825 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16826 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16827 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16828 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830 ACL derivatives :
16831 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16832 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16833 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16834 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16835 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16836 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16837 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16838 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16839
16840res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16841shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16842 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16843 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16844 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16845 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16846 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016848res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16849shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16850 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16851 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16852 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16853 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16854 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16855 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016856
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016857res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16858 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16859 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16860 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16861 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16864shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16865 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16866 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16867 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16868 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16869 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16870 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016872res.ver : string
16873resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16874 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16875 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877 ACL derivatives :
16878 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16881 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16882 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016883 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016886 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16887 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889status : integer
16890 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16891 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16892 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016893
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016894unique-id : string
16895 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16896 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16897 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16898 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16899 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16900 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902url : string
16903 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16904 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16905 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16906 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16907 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16908 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16909 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911 ACL derivatives :
16912 url : exact string match
16913 url_beg : prefix match
16914 url_dir : subdir match
16915 url_dom : domain match
16916 url_end : suffix match
16917 url_len : length match
16918 url_reg : regex match
16919 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921url_ip : ip
16922 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16923 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16924 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16925 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16926 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16927 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16928 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930url_port : integer
16931 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16932 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16933 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16934 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016935
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016936urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16937url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16939 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016940 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16941 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16942 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16943 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16945 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016946 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16947 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016949 ACL derivatives :
16950 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16951 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16952 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16953 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16954 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16955 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16956 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16957 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016958
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016960 Example :
16961 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16962 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16963 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16964 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016965
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016966urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016967 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16968 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16969 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016970
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016971url32 : integer
16972 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16973 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16974 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16975 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16976 is an unsigned integer.
16977
16978url32+src : binary
16979 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16980 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16981 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16982
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016985---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016987Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16988every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016989order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016991ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16992---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016993FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016994HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016995HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16996HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016997HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16998HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16999HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17000HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17001LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017002METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017003METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017004METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17005METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17006METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17007METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017008METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017009METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017010RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017011REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017012TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017013WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17014---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017015
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170178. Logging
17018----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017020One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17021provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17022very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17023provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17024state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017025to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026headers.
17027
17028In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17029about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17030send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17031
17032 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17033 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17034 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17035 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17036 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017037 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017038 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039
17040The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17041allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17042as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17043while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17044real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17045delay.
17046
17047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170488.1. Log levels
17049---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017051TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017053HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17054in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17055track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17056syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17057about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017058
17059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170608.2. Log formats
17061----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017062
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017063HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017064and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17065slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17066options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067
17068 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17069 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17070 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17071 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17072 extents.
17073
17074 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17075 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17076 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17077 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17078 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17079
17080 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17081 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17082 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17083 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17084 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17085
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017086 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17087 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17088 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17089 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17090
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017091 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17092
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017093Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17094specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17095field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17096servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17097always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17098identifier.
17099
17100Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17101 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17102 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17103 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17104 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17105
17106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171078.2.1. Default log format
17108-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017109
17110This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17111as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17112format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17113
17114 Example :
17115 listen www
17116 mode http
17117 log global
17118 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17119
17120 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17121 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17122 (www/HTTP)
17123
17124 Field Format Extract from the example above
17125 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17126 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17127 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17128 4 'to' to
17129 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17130 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17131
17132Detailed fields description :
17133 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17134 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17135 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17136 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17137 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17138 and processed the connection.
17139 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17140
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017141In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17142"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17143connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17144
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017145It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17146will eventually disappear.
17147
17148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171498.2.2. TCP log format
17150---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017151
17152The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17153is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17154information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17155counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17156emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17157environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17158the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17159sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017160specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17161not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17162fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17163marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017164
17165 Example :
17166 frontend fnt
17167 mode tcp
17168 option tcplog
17169 log global
17170 default_backend bck
17171
17172 backend bck
17173 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17174
17175 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17176 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17177 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17178
17179 Field Format Extract from the example above
17180 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17181 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17182 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17183 4 frontend_name fnt
17184 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17185 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17186 7 bytes_read* 212
17187 8 termination_state --
17188 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17189 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17190
17191Detailed fields description :
17192 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017193 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17194 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17195 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017196 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017197 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017198 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199
17200 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017201 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17202 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17203 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017204
17205 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17206 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17207 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017208 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17209 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17210 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17211 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017212
17213 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17214 and processed the connection.
17215
17216 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17217 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17218 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17219 applications.
17220
17221 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17222 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17223 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17224 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17225 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17226
17227 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17228 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17229 See "Timers" below for more details.
17230
17231 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17232 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17233 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17234 "Timers" below for more details.
17235
17236 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017237 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017238 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17239 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17240 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17241 details.
17242
17243 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17244 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17245 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17246 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17247 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17248
17249 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17250 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17251 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17252 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17253 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17254 for more details.
17255
17256 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017257 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017258 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17259 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17260 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017261 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017262
17263 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17264 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17265 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17266 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17267 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17268 caused by a denial of service attack.
17269
17270 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17271 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17272 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17273 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17274 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17275 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17276 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17277 denial of service attack.
17278
17279 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17280 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17281 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17282 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17283 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17284 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17285 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17286 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17287 be processed than on other servers.
17288
17289 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17290 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17291 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17292 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17293 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17294 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17295 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17296 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17297 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17298 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17299 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17300 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17301 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17302
17303 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17304 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17305 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17306 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17307 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17308 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017309 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017310 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17311
17312 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17313 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17314 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17315 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17316 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17317 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017318 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017319 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17320 occurs.
17321
17322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173238.2.3. HTTP log format
17324----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325
17326The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17327is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17328the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17329are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17330emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17331generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17332"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17333which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017334frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17335is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336
17337Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17338slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17339with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17340
17341 Example :
17342 frontend http-in
17343 mode http
17344 option httplog
17345 log global
17346 default_backend bck
17347
17348 backend static
17349 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17350
17351 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17352 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17353 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017354 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017355
17356 Field Format Extract from the example above
17357 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17358 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017359 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360 4 frontend_name http-in
17361 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017362 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017363 7 status_code 200
17364 8 bytes_read* 2750
17365 9 captured_request_cookie -
17366 10 captured_response_cookie -
17367 11 termination_state ----
17368 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17369 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17370 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17371 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17372 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017373
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017374Detailed fields description :
17375 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017376 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17377 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17378 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017379 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017380 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017381 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017382
17383 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017384 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17385 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17386 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017387
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017388 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17389 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390
17391 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17392 and processed the connection.
17393
17394 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17395 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17396 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17397
17398 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17399 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17400 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17401 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17402 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17403 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17404
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017405 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17406 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17407 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017408 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017409 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17410 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017411 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17412 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413
17414 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17415 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017416 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417
17418 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17419 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017420 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17421 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017422
17423 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17424 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17425 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17426 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17427 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017428 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17429 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017431 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17432 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17433 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17434 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17435 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17436 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17437 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017438 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017439
17440 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17441 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17442 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17443
17444 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17445 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017446 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17448 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17449 overflowing.
17450
17451 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17452 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17453 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17454 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17455 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17456 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17457 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17458 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17459
17460 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17461 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17462 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17463 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17464 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17465 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17466 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17467 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17468
17469 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17470 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17471 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17472 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17473 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17474 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17475 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17476
17477 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017478 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017479 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17480 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17481 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017482 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483 system.
17484
17485 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17486 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17487 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17488 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17489 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17490 caused by a denial of service attack.
17491
17492 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17493 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17494 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17495 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17496 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17497 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17498 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17499 denial of service attack.
17500
17501 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17502 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17503 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17504 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17505 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17506 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17507 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17508 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17509 processed than on other servers.
17510
17511 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17512 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17513 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17514 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17515 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17516 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17517 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17518 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17519 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17520 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17521 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17522 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17523 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17524
17525 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17526 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17527 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17528 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17529 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17530 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017531 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17533
17534 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17535 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17536 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17537 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17538 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17539 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017540 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017541 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17542 occurs.
17543
17544 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17545 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17546 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17547 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17548 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17549 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17550 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17551 cookies" below for more details.
17552
17553 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17554 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17555 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17556 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17557 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17558 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17559 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17560 and cookies" below for more details.
17561
17562 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17563 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17564 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17565 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17566 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17567 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17568 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17569 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17570
17571
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175728.2.4. Custom log format
17573------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017574
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017575The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017576mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017577
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017578HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017579Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17580separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17581prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17582
17583Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17584variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017585("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017586
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017587If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017588as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017589less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17590the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17591
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017592Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017593In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017594in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017595
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017596Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17597'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17598https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17599such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17600
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017601Flags are :
17602 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017603 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017604 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17605 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017606
17607 Example:
17608
17609 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17610 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17611
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017612 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17613
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017614At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017616 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17617 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017618
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017619the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017620
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017621 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17622 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17623 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017624
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017625and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17626
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017627 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17628 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017629
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017630Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17631
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017632 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017633 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017634 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17635 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17636 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017637 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17638 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17639 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017640 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017641 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17642 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017643 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017644 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17645 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017646 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017647 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017648 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017649 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017650 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017651 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017652 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017653 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17654 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17655 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17656 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17657 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017658 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017659 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17660 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017661 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017662 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17663 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017664 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17665 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17666 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017667 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017668 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17669 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017670 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017671 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17672 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17673 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017674 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017675 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017676 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17677 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17678 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17679 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017680 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017681 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017682 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017683 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017684 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017685 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017686 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17687 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17688 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017689 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017690 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17691 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017692 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017693 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17694 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017695 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017696 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017697 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017698 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017699
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017700 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017701
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017702
177038.2.5. Error log format
17704-----------------------
17705
17706When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17707protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17708By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17709"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017710will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017711logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17712
17713The format looks like this :
17714
17715 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17716 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17717 Connection error during SSL handshake
17718
17719 Field Format Extract from the example above
17720 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17721 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17722 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17723 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17724 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17725
17726These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17727failures.
17728
17729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177308.3. Advanced logging options
17731-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017732
17733Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17734just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17735options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17736for more information about their usage.
17737
17738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177398.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17740------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017741
17742It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17743haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17744commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17745monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17746ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17747
17748 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17749 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17750 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17751 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17752
17753 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17754 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17755 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017756 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017757 such as other load-balancers.
17758
17759 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17760 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17761 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17762
17763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177648.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17765----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017766
17767The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17768what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17769or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017770"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017771just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17772log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17773after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17774is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17775with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17776with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17777
17778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177798.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17780------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017781
17782Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17783for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17784"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17785retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17786raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17787a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17788file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17789you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17790"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17791
17792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177938.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17794--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017795
17796Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17797multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17798them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17799"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17800logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17801error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17802and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17803too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17804useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17805alternative.
17806
17807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178088.4. Timing events
17809------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810
17811Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17812reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17813the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17814frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017815mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17816addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17817
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017818Timings events in HTTP mode:
17819
17820 first request 2nd request
17821 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17822 t tr t tr ...
17823 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17824 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17825 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17826 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17827 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17828
17829Timings events in TCP mode:
17830
17831 TCP session
17832 |<----------------->|
17833 t t
17834 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17835 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17836 |<------ Tt ------->|
17837
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017838 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017839 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017840 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17841 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17842 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017843 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017844 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17845 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17846 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17847 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017848
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017849 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17850 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17851 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017852 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17853 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17854 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17855 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17856 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17857 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017858
17859 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17860 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17861 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17862 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17863 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17864 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17865 request typed by hand during a test.
17866
17867 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17868 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017869 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017870 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17871 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17872 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17873 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017874
17875 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17876 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17877 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17878 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17879 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17880
17881 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17882 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17883 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17884 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17885 connection never established.
17886
17887 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17888 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17889 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17890 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17891 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17892 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17893 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17894 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17895 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17896 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17897 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017899 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17900 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17901 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17902 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17903 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17904 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17905
17906 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17907
17908 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17909 "Ta" can never be negative.
17910
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17912 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017913 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17914 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017915 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017917 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017918
17919 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017920 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17921 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017922
17923These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17924protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17925that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017926due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17927"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17928that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017929
17930Most common cases :
17931
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017932 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17933 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17934 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17935 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17936 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17937 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17938 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17939 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17940 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17941 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17942 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017943 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017944
17945 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17946 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17947 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17948 of ms on remote networks.
17949
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017950 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17951 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17952 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017953
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017954 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17955 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17956 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17957 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17958 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17959 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17960 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17961 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17962 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017963
17964Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017966 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017967 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017968 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017969
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017970 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017971 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17972 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17973
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017974 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017975 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17976 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17977 flags.
17978
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017979 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17980 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017981 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17982 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17983 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17984 the client connection was maintained open.
17985
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017986 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017987 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017988 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017989 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17990
17991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179928.5. Session state at disconnection
17993-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017994
17995TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17996"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179972-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17998each of which has a special meaning :
17999
18000 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18001 session to terminate :
18002
18003 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18004
18005 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18006 server explicitly refused it.
18007
18008 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18009 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18010 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18011 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018012 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018013
18014 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18015 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018016
18017 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18018 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18019 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18020 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18021 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18022
18023 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18024 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18025 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18026 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18027 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18028
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018029 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18030 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18031
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018032 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18033 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18034 backup connections when going up.
18035
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018036 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018038 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18039 send or receive data.
18040
18041 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18042 send or receive data.
18043
18044 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18045 with nothing left in the buffers.
18046
18047 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18048
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018049 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018050 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18051
18052 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18053 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18054 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18055 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18056 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18057
18058 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18059 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18060
18061 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18062 server (HTTP only).
18063
18064 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18065
18066 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18067 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18068 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18069
18070 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18071 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18072 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18073
18074 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18075
18076 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18077 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18078
18079 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18080 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18081 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18082
18083 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18084 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018085 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18086 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087
18088 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18089 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18090 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18091 another server.
18092
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018093 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018094 server.
18095
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018096 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18097 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18098 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18099 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18100
18101 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18102 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18103 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18104 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18105
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018106 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18107 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18108 "use-server" rule).
18109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018110 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18111
18112 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18113 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18114
18115 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18116
18117 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18118 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18119 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18120
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018121 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18122 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018123 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018124 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18125 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018127 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18128
18129 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18130 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18131
18132 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18133
18134 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018136The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18137was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018138helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18139starvation, attacks, etc...
18140
18141The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18142alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18143easier finding and understanding.
18144
18145 Flags Reason
18146
18147 -- Normal termination.
18148
18149 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18150 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18151 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18152 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18153
18154 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18155 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18156 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18157 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18158 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18159 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018161 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18162 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018163 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018164
18165 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18166 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18167 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18168
18169 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18170 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18171 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18172 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18173 the server takes too long to respond.
18174
18175 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18176 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18177 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18178 long a time to respond.
18179
18180 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18181 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18182 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18183 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018184 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18185 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018186
18187 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18188 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18189 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18190 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18191 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018192 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018193 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18194 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18195 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18196 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18197 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18198 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18199 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18200 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018202 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18203 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18204 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018205
18206 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18207 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018208 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18209 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18210 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18211 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018212
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018213 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18214 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018216 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018217 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18218 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018219 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018220 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18221 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18222
18223 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18224 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18225 503 or 504 here.
18226
18227 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18228 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18229 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18230 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18231 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18232
18233 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18234 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018235 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018236 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18237 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18238
18239 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18240 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18241 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18242 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18243 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18244 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18245 between haproxy and the server.
18246
18247 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18248 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18249 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18250 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18251 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18252 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18253 solution is to fix the application.
18254
18255 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18256 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18257 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18258 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18259 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18260 external attacks.
18261
18262 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070018263 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018264 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018265 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18266 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18267
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018268 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18269 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18270 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018271 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018272 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018273
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018274 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18275 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18276 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18277 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018278 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18279 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18280 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18281 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18282 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018283
18284 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18285 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18286 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18287 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18288
18289 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18290 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18291 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18292 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18293
18294 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18295 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18296 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18297 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018299The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18300persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18301important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18302re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18303
18304 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18305
18306 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18307 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18308 set on a GET request.
18309
18310 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18311 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018312 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018313 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18314
18315 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18316 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18317 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18318
18319 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18320 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18321 already got a cookie.
18322
18323 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18324 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18325 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18326 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18327 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18328
18329 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18330 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18331 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18332
18333 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18334 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18335 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18336
18337 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18338 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18339
18340 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18341 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18342 then advertised in the response.
18343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183458.6. Non-printable characters
18346-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018347
18348In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18349consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18350converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18351prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18352being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18353escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18354is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18355'}' when logging headers.
18356
18357Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18358issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18359containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18360
18361Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18362the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18363performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18364
18365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18367---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018368
18369Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18370achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018371section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018372cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18373the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18374the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018375locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018376not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18377user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18378a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18379wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18380
18381 Examples :
18382 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18383 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18384
18385 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18386 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18387
18388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18390---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391
18392Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18393proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18394the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18395server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18396
18397Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18398response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018399section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018400
18401It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018402time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18403appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018404are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18405and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18406follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18407request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18408in the logs.
18409
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018410As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18411frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18412an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18413
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018414 Example :
18415 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18416 listen proxy-out
18417 mode http
18418 option httplog
18419 option logasap
18420 log global
18421 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18422
18423 # log the name of the virtual server
18424 capture request header Host len 20
18425
18426 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18427 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18428
18429 # log the beginning of the referrer
18430 capture request header Referer len 20
18431
18432 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18433 capture response header Server len 20
18434
18435 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18436 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18437
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018438 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018439 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18440
18441 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18442 capture response header Via len 20
18443
18444 # log the URL location during a redirection
18445 capture response header Location len 20
18446
18447 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18448 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18449 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18450 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18451 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18452
18453 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18454 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18455 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18456 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018457 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018458
18459 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18460 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18461 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18462 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18463 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018464 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018465
18466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184678.9. Examples of logs
18468---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018469
18470These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18471them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18472reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18473
18474 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18475 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18476 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18477
18478 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18479 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18480
18481 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18482 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18483 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18484
18485 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18486 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18487
18488 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18489 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18490 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18491
18492 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018493 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018494 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18495 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18496
18497 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18498 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18499 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18500
18501 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18502 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018503 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018504 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18505 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18506 to return the 502 and not the server.
18507
18508 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018509 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018510
18511 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18512 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18513 Nothing was sent to any server.
18514
18515 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18516 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18517
18518 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18519 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018520 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018521 send a 408 return code to the client.
18522
18523 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18524 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18525
18526 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18527 5 seconds ("c----").
18528
18529 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18530 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018531 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018532
18533 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018534 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018535 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18536 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18537 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18538 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18539 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018540
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018541
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185429. Supported filters
18543--------------------
18544
18545Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18546accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18547unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18548
18549See also : "filter"
18550
185519.1. Trace
18552----------
18553
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018554filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018555
18556 Arguments:
18557 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18558 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18559
18560 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18561 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18562 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18563 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018565 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018566 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18567 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18568 amount of the parsed data.
18569
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018570 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018571
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018572This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18573callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18574information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18575filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18576
18577Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18578tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18579a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18580
18581
185829.2. HTTP compression
18583---------------------
18584
18585filter compression
18586
18587The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18588keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018589when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18590it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18591response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18592line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18593cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18594the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018595
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018596See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018597
18598
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185999.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18600--------------------------------------------
18601
18602filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18603
18604 Arguments :
18605
18606 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18607 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18608 parsed.
18609
18610 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18611 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18612 part must be placed in its own scope.
18613
18614The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18615external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018616streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018617exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18618also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18619
18620SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18621the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18622
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018623For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018624"doc/SPOE.txt".
18625
18626Important note:
18627 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18628 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18629
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186309.4. Cache
18631----------
18632
18633filter cache <name>
18634
18635 Arguments :
18636
18637 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18638
18639The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18640"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018641cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018642other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18643the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18644mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18645filter other than the compression is used for the same
18646listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18647order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018648
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018649See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018650
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001865110. Cache
18652---------
18653
18654HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18655(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18656RAM.
18657
18658The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018659this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018660
18661If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18662independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18663when we try to allocate a new one.
18664
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018665The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018666
18667It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18668"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18669for more details.
18670
18671When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18672replaced by "<CACHE>".
18673
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001867410.1. Limitation
18675----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018676
18677The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18678
18679- If the response is not a 200
18680- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018681- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018682- If the response is not cacheable
18683
18684- If the request is not a GET
18685- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018686- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018687
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018688Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18689filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18690can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18691example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18692"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018693
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001869410.2. Setup
18695-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018696
18697To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18698the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18699
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001870010.2.1. Cache section
18701---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018702
18703cache <name>
18704 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18705 size of cache is mandatory.
18706
18707total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018708 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018709 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018710
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018711max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018712 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18713 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18714 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018715
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018716max-age <seconds>
18717 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18718 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18719 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18720 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18721 default.
18722
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001872310.2.2. Proxy section
18724---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018725
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018726http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018727 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18728 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18729 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18730 after this one.
18731
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018732http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018733 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18734 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18735 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18736 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18737
18738
18739Example:
18740
18741 backend bck1
18742 mode http
18743
18744 http-request cache-use foobar
18745 http-response cache-store foobar
18746 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18747
18748 cache foobar
18749 total-max-size 4
18750 max-age 240
18751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018752/*
18753 * Local variables:
18754 * fill-column: 79
18755 * End:
18756 */